blob: a05644d755ee929bdb931d1d9f0d94cf1a6435b4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau37242fa2010-08-28 19:21:00 +02007 2010/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -d
421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100446 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100447
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 * Performance tuning
449 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100450 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 - noepoll
452 - nokqueue
453 - nopoll
454 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100455 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200456 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200457 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200458 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100459 - tune.maxaccept
460 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100462 - tune.rcvbuf.client
463 - tune.rcvbuf.server
464 - tune.sndbuf.client
465 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Debugging
468 - debug
469 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200470
471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004723.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473------------------------------------
474
475chroot <jail dir>
476 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
477 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
478 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
479 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
480 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
481 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100482
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200483daemon
484 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
485 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
486 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
487
488gid <number>
489 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
490 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
491 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
492 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494group <group name>
495 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
496 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100497
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200498log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
500 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100501 configured with "log global".
502
503 <address> can be one of:
504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100505 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
507 port).
508
509 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
510 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
511 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
512 writeable).
513
514 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515
516 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
517 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
518 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
519
520 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200521 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
522 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
523 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
524 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
525 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
526 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527
528 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
529
530nbproc <number>
531 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
532 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
533 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
534 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
535 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
536
537pidfile <pidfile>
538 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
539 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
540 starting the process. See also "daemon".
541
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200542stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200543 [level <level>]
544
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200545 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
546 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100547 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200548 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
549
550 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
551 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
552 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
553 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
554 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
555
556 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
557 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
558 counters).
559
560 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
561 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100562
563 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
564 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
565 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
566 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
567 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
568 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
569 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200570
571stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
572 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
573 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100574 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200575
576stats maxconn <connections>
577 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
578 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
579
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580uid <number>
581 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
582 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
583 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
584 one. See also "gid" and "user".
585
586ulimit-n <number>
587 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
588 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
589 option.
590
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100591unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
592 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
593
594 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
595 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
596 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
597 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
598 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
599 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
600 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
601 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
602 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
603 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605user <user name>
606 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
607 See also "uid" and "group".
608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200609node <name>
610 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
611
612 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
613 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
614 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
615 traffic.
616
617description <text>
618 Add a text that describes the instance.
619
620 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
621 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
622 "<" and ">" characters.
623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626-----------------------
627
628maxconn <number>
629 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
630 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
631 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
632 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
633
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100634maxpipes <number>
635 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
636 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
637 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
638 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
639 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
640 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642noepoll
643 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
644 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
645 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
646
647nokqueue
648 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
649 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
650 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
651
652nopoll
653 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
654 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100655 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
657 "nokqueue".
658
659nosepoll
660 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
661 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
662 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
663
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664nosplice
665 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
666 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
667 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100668 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100669 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
670 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
671 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
672 "option splice-response".
673
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200674spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
675 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
676 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
677 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
678 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
679 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
680
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200681tune.bufsize <number>
682 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
683 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
684 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
685 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
686 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
687 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
688 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
689 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
690
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200691tune.chksize <number>
692 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
693 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
694 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
695 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
696 checks whenever possible.
697
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100698tune.maxaccept <number>
699 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
700 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
701 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100702 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100703 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
704 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100705 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100706 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
707
708tune.maxpollevents <number>
709 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
710 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
711 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
712 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
713 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
714
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200715tune.maxrewrite <number>
716 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
717 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
718 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
719 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
720 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
721 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
722 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
723 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
724 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
725 bufsize.
726
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100727tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
728tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
729 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
730 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
731 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
732 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
733 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
734 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
735 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
736
737tune.sndbuf.client <number>
738tune.sndbuf.server <number>
739 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
740 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
741 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
742 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
743 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
744 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
745 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
746 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
747 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
748 notifying haproxy again.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.3. Debugging
752--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
754debug
755 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
756 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
757 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
758 system startup.
759
760quiet
761 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
762 line argument "-q".
763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007643.4. Userlists
765--------------
766It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
767http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
768it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
769
770userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100771 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100772 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
773
774group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100775 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100776 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
777 proceeded by "users" keyword.
778
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100779user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
780 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100781 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
782 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100783 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
784 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100785 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
786 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
787
788
789 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100790 userlist L1
791 group G1 users tiger,scott
792 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100793
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100794 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
795 user scott insecure-password elgato
796 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100797
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100798 userlist L2
799 group G1
800 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100801
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100802 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
803 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
804 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100805
806 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008084. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200809----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100810
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200811Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
812 - defaults <name>
813 - frontend <name>
814 - backend <name>
815 - listen <name>
816
817A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
818its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
819section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100820section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200821
822A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
823connections.
824
825A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
826to forward incoming connections.
827
828A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
829parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100831All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
832'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
833case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
834
835Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
836logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
837proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
838However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
839name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
840
841Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
842and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100843bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100844protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
845modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
846arbitrary criteria.
847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008494.1. Proxy keywords matrix
850--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200852The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
853limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
854they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
855limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100856marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200857option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200858and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
859with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
860specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100861
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200862
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100863 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
864------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
865acl - X X X
866appsession - - X X
867backlog X X X -
868balance X - X X
869bind - X X -
870bind-process X X X X
871block - X X X
872capture cookie - X X -
873capture request header - X X -
874capture response header - X X -
875clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
876contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
877cookie X - X X
878default-server X - X X
879default_backend X X X -
880description - X X X
881disabled X X X X
882dispatch - - X X
883enabled X X X X
884errorfile X X X X
885errorloc X X X X
886errorloc302 X X X X
887-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
888errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200889force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100890fullconn X - X X
891grace X X X X
892hash-type X - X X
893http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100894http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200895http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100896http-request - X X X
897id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200898ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100899log X X X X
900maxconn X X X -
901mode X X X X
902monitor fail - X X -
903monitor-net X X X -
904monitor-uri X X X -
905option abortonclose (*) X - X X
906option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
907option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
908option allbackups (*) X - X X
909option checkcache (*) X - X X
910option clitcpka (*) X X X -
911option contstats (*) X X X -
912option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
913option dontlognull (*) X X X -
914option forceclose (*) X X X X
915-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
916option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200917option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100918option http-server-close (*) X X X X
919option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
920option httpchk X - X X
921option httpclose (*) X X X X
922option httplog X X X X
923option http_proxy (*) X X X X
924option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200925option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100926option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
927option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
928option logasap (*) X X X -
929option mysql-check X - X X
930option nolinger (*) X X X X
931option originalto X X X X
932option persist (*) X - X X
933option redispatch (*) X - X X
934option smtpchk X - X X
935option socket-stats (*) X X X -
936option splice-auto (*) X X X X
937option splice-request (*) X X X X
938option splice-response (*) X X X X
939option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
940option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
941-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
942option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
943option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
944option tcpka X X X X
945option tcplog X X X X
946option transparent (*) X - X X
947persist rdp-cookie X - X X
948rate-limit sessions X X X -
949redirect - X X X
950redisp (deprecated) X - X X
951redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
952reqadd - X X X
953reqallow - X X X
954reqdel - X X X
955reqdeny - X X X
956reqiallow - X X X
957reqidel - X X X
958reqideny - X X X
959reqipass - X X X
960reqirep - X X X
961reqisetbe - X X X
962reqitarpit - X X X
963reqpass - X X X
964reqrep - X X X
965-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
966reqsetbe - X X X
967reqtarpit - X X X
968retries X - X X
969rspadd - X X X
970rspdel - X X X
971rspdeny - X X X
972rspidel - X X X
973rspideny - X X X
974rspirep - X X X
975rsprep - X X X
976server - - X X
977source X - X X
978srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200979stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100980stats auth X - X X
981stats enable X - X X
982stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200983stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100984stats realm X - X X
985stats refresh X - X X
986stats scope X - X X
987stats show-desc X - X X
988stats show-legends X - X X
989stats show-node X - X X
990stats uri X - X X
991-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
992stick match - - X X
993stick on - - X X
994stick store-request - - X X
995stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200996tcp-request connection - X X -
997tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +0200998tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100999timeout check X - X X
1000timeout client X X X -
1001timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1002timeout connect X - X X
1003timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1004timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1005timeout http-request X X X X
1006timeout queue X - X X
1007timeout server X - X X
1008timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1009timeout tarpit X X X X
1010transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1011use_backend - X X -
1012------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1013 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010164.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1017---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001018
1019This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1020
1021
1022acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1023 Declare or complete an access list.
1024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1025 no | yes | yes | yes
1026 Example:
1027 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1028 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1029 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001031 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001032
1033
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001034appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1035 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001036 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1038 no | no | yes | yes
1039 Arguments :
1040 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1041 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1042
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001043 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001044 checked in each cookie value.
1045
1046 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1047 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1048 milliseconds.
1049
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001050 request-learn
1051 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1052 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1053 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1054 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1055 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1056 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1057
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001058 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1059 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1060 data following this prefix.
1061
1062 Example :
1063 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1064
1065 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1066 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1067
1068 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1069 2 modes are currently supported :
1070 - path-parameters :
1071 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1072 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1073 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1074 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1075 - query-string :
1076 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1077 query string.
1078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001079 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1080 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1081 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1082 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001083 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1084 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1085 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001086 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1087 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1088
1089 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1090
1091 Example :
1092 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1093
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001094 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001095 and "ignore-persist"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001096
1097
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001098backlog <conns>
1099 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1101 yes | yes | yes | no
1102 Arguments :
1103 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1104 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1105 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1106
1107 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1108 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1109 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1110 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1111 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1112 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1113 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1114 backlog parameter.
1115
1116 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1117 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1118 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1119
1120 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1121
1122
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001123balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001124balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001125 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1127 yes | no | yes | yes
1128 Arguments :
1129 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1130 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1131 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1132 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1133
1134 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1135 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1136 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1137 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001138 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1139 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1140 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1141 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1142 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1143 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1144 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1145 it, so that you don't worry.
1146
1147 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1148 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1149 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1150 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1151 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1152 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1153 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1154 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001155
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001156 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1157 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1158 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1159 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1160 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1161 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1162 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1163 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001165 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1166 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1167 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1168 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1169 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1170 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1171 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1172 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001173 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001174 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001175 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1176 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1177 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001178
1179 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1180 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1181 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1182 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1183 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1184 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1185 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001186 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1187 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1188 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001190 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1191 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1192 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1193 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1194 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1195 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1196 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1197 URIs start with a leading "/".
1198
1199 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1200 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1201 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1202 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001204 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001205 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1206
1207 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1208 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1209 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1210 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1211 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1212 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1213 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1214 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1215 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1216 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1217 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1218 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1219 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1220 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1221 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1222 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1223 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1224 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1225 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1226 be randomly balanced if at all.
1227
1228 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1229 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1230 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1231 server will receive the request.
1232
1233 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1234 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1235 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1236 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1237 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001238 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1239 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1240 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001242 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1243 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1244 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001245 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001246 algorithm is applied instead.
1247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001248 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001249 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1250 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1251 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1252
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001253 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1254 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1255 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1256
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001257 rdp-cookie
1258 rdp-cookie(name)
1259 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1260 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1261 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1262 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1263 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1264 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001265 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001266 used instead.
1267
1268 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1269 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1270 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1271 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1272
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001273 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1274 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1275 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1276
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001277 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001278 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1279 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001280
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001281 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001282 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001283
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001284 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1285 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1286 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001287
1288 Examples :
1289 balance roundrobin
1290 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001291 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001292 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1293 balance hdr(host)
1294 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001295
1296 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1297 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001299 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001300 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1301 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1302 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1303 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1304
1305 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1306 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1307 defaults to 16 kB.
1308
1309 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1310 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1311
1312 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1313 Round Robin.
1314
1315 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1316 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1317 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1318 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1319
1320 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1321
1322 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001323 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001324 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1325 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1326 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001327
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001328 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1329 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001330
1331
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001332bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1333bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1334bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1335bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1336bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1337bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1338bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001339bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001340bind /<path> [, ...]
1341bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1342bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1343bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1346 no | yes | yes | no
1347 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001348 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1349 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1350 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1351 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1352 special address "0.0.0.0".
1353
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001354 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1355 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001356 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1357 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1358 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001359 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1360 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1361 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1362 the range.
1363
1364 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1365 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1366 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1367 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1368 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1369 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1370 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1371 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1372 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001373
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001374 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1375 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1376 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1377 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1378 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1379 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1380 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1381 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1382
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001383 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1384 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1385 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1386 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1387 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1388 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1389 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1390 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001391 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1392 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001393
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001394 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1395 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1396 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1397 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1398 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1399 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1400 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1401 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001402 This parameter is only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001403
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001404 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1405 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1406 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1407 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001408
1409 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1410
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001411 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1412 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1413 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1414 simply ignore this.
1415
1416 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1417 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1418 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1419 simply ignore this.
1420
1421 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1422 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1423 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1424 this.
1425
1426 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1427 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1428 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1429 this.
1430
1431 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1432 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1433 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1434 this.
1435
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001436 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1437 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1438 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001439 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001440 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1441 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1442 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1443 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001444 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1445 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001446
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001447 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001448 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1449 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1450 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1451 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1452 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1453 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1454 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1455 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1456 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1457 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1458 with front firewalls which would see an established
1459 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1460
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001461 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1462 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1463 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1464 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1465 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1466 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1467 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1468 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1469 This keyword combined with support from external components
1470 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1471 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1472 not even always usable.
1473
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1475 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1476 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1477 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1478 in a frontend.
1479
1480 Example :
1481 listen http_proxy
1482 bind :80,:443
1483 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001484 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001486 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001487 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001488
1489
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001490bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1491 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 yes | yes | yes | yes
1494 Arguments :
1495 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1496 may be used to override a default value.
1497
1498 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1499 option may be combined with other numbers.
1500
1501 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1502 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1503 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1504 missing from all processes.
1505
1506 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1507 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1508 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1509 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1510
1511 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1512 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1513 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1514 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1515 and 'even' instances.
1516
1517 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1518 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1519 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1520 32.
1521
1522 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1523 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1524
1525 Example :
1526 listen app_ip1
1527 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001528 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001529
1530 listen app_ip2
1531 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001532 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001533
1534 listen management
1535 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001536 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001537
1538 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1539
1540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541block { if | unless } <condition>
1542 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1544 no | yes | yes | yes
1545
1546 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1547 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001548 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001549 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1550 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1551 "block" statements per instance.
1552
1553 Example:
1554 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1555 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1556 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1557 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001559 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001560
1561
1562capture cookie <name> len <length>
1563 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1565 no | yes | yes | no
1566 Arguments :
1567 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1568 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1569 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1570 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1571 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1572
1573 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1574 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1575 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1576 right if it exceeds <length>.
1577
1578 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1579 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1580 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1581 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1582
1583 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1584 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1585 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1586
1587 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1588 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1589 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1590 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001591 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001592 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1593
1594 Example:
1595 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1596
1597 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001598 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599
1600
1601capture request header <name> len <length>
1602 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1604 no | yes | yes | no
1605 Arguments :
1606 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001607 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001608 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1609 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1610 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1611
1612 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1613 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1614 it exceeds <length>.
1615
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001616 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1618 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001619 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1620 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1621 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1622 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001623 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001624 environments to find where the request came from.
1625
1626 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1627 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1628 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1629 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001630
1631 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1632 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1633 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1634 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1635
1636 Example:
1637 capture request header Host len 15
1638 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1639 capture request header Referrer len 15
1640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001641 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 about logging.
1643
1644
1645capture response header <name> len <length>
1646 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1648 no | yes | yes | no
1649 Arguments :
1650 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001651 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001652 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1653 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1654 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1655
1656 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1657 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1658 it exceeds <length>.
1659
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001660 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001661 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1662 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1663 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001664 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1665 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1666 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1667 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668
1669 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1670 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1671 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1672 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1673
1674 Example:
1675 capture response header Content-length len 9
1676 capture response header Location len 15
1677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001678 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679 about logging.
1680
1681
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001682clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1685 yes | yes | yes | no
1686 Arguments :
1687 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1688 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1689 as explained at the top of this document.
1690
1691 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1692 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1693 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1694 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1695 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1696 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1697 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1698 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001699 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1701 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1702
1703 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1704 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1705 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1706 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1707 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1708 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1709
1710 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1711 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1712
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001713 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1714 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715
1716
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001717contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1720 yes | no | yes | yes
1721 Arguments :
1722 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1723 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1724 as explained at the top of this document.
1725
1726 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001727 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001728 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001729 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1730 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1731 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1732 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1733
1734 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1735 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1736 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1737 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1738 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1739 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1740
1741 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1742 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1743 instead.
1744
1745 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1746 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1747
1748
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001749cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001750 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001751 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001752 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1754 yes | no | yes | yes
1755 Arguments :
1756 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1757 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1758 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1759 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1760 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1761 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1762 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1763 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1764 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1765
1766 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1767 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1768 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1769 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1770 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1771 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1772 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1773 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1774 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1775 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1776 "insert" and "prefix".
1777
1778 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001779 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001780
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001781 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001782 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1783 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1784 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1785 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1786 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1787 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1788 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1789 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1790 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1791 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792
1793 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1794 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1795 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1796 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1797 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1798 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1799 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1800 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1801 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1802 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1803 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1804
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001805 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1806 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1807 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001808 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1809 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1810 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1811 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001812
1813 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1814 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1815 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1816 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1817 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1818 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1819 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1820 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1821 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1822
1823 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1824 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1825 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1826 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1827 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1828 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1829 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1830 persistence cookie in the cache.
1831 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1832
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001833 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1834 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1835 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1836 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1837 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1838 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1839 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1840 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1841 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1842 they logout.
1843
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001844 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001845 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001846 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1847 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1848 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1849 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1850 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1851 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001852
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001853 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1854 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1855 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1856 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1857 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1858 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1859 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1860 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1861 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1862 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1863 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1864 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1865 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1866 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1867 the site.
1868
1869 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1870 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1871 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1872 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1873 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1874 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1875 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1876 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1877 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1878 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1879 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1880 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1881 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1882 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1883 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1884 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001886 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1887 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1888 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1889 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001891 Examples :
1892 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1893 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1894 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001895 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001897 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001898 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001901default-server [param*]
1902 Change default options for a server in a backend
1903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1904 yes | no | yes | yes
1905 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001906 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1907 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1908 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1909 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001910
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001911 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001912 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1913
1914 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001915
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001917default_backend <backend>
1918 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1920 yes | yes | yes | no
1921 Arguments :
1922 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1923
1924 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1925 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1926 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1927 will catch all undetermined requests.
1928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001929 Example :
1930
1931 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1932 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1933 default_backend dynamic
1934
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001935 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001937
1938disabled
1939 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1941 yes | yes | yes | yes
1942 Arguments : none
1943
1944 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
1945 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
1946 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
1947 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
1948 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
1949 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
1950 keyword in a "defaults" section.
1951
1952 See also : "enabled"
1953
1954
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02001955dispatch <address>:<port>
1956 Set a default server address
1957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1958 no | no | yes | yes
1959 Arguments : none
1960
1961 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
1962 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
1963 during start-up.
1964
1965 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
1966 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
1967 possible with normal servers.
1968
1969 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
1970 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
1971 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
1972 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
1973 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
1974
1975 See also : "server"
1976
1977
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001978enabled
1979 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1981 yes | yes | yes | yes
1982 Arguments : none
1983
1984 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
1985 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
1986
1987 See also : "disabled"
1988
1989
1990errorfile <code> <file>
1991 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1993 yes | yes | yes | yes
1994 Arguments :
1995 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1996 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1997
1998 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001999 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002001 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2002 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003
2004 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2005 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2006 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2007
2008 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2009 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2010 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2011 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2012
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002013 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2014 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2015 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2016 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2017 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2018 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2021 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2022 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002023 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2025
2026 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2027
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002028 Example :
2029 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2030 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2031 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2032
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002033
2034errorloc <code> <url>
2035errorloc302 <code> <url>
2036 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2038 yes | yes | yes | yes
2039 Arguments :
2040 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2041 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2042
2043 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2044 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2045 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2046 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2047 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2048
2049 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2050 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2051 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2052
2053 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2054 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2055 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2056 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2057 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2058 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2059 request.
2060
2061 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2062
2063
2064errorloc303 <code> <url>
2065 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2067 yes | yes | yes | yes
2068 Arguments :
2069 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2070 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2071
2072 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2073 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2074 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2075 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2076 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2077
2078 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2079 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2080 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2081
2082 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2083 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2084 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2085 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002086 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002087
2088 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2089
2090
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002091force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2092 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2093 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2094 no | yes | yes | yes
2095
2096 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2097 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2098 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2099 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2100 marked down for maintenance operations.
2101
2102 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2103 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2104 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2105 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2106 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2107 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2108 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2109 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2110 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2111
2112 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2113 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2114 is used.
2115
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002116 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002117 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002118
2119
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002120fullconn <conns>
2121 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2123 yes | no | yes | yes
2124 Arguments :
2125 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2126 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2127
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002128 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002129 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002130 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002131 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2132 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2133 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2134 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2135 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002136 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002137
2138 Example :
2139 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2140 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2141 # connections.
2142 backend dynamic
2143 fullconn 10000
2144 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2145 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2146
2147 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2148
2149
2150grace <time>
2151 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002153 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002154 Arguments :
2155 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2156 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2157 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2158
2159 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2160 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002161 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002162 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2163
2164 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2165 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2166 simplify it.
2167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002168
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002169hash-type <method>
2170 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2172 yes | no | yes | yes
2173 Arguments :
2174 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2175 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2176 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2177 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2178 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2179 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2180 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2181 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2182 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2183
2184 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2185 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2186 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2187 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2188 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2189 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2190 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2191 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2192 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2193 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2194 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2195 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2196 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2197
2198 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2199
2200 See also : "balance", "server"
2201
2202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203http-check disable-on-404
2204 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002206 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207 Arguments : none
2208
2209 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2210 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2211 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2212 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2213 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2214 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2215 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2216 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002217 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2218 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2219 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2220
2221 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2222
2223
2224http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2225 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2227 no | no | yes | yes
2228 Arguments :
2229 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2230 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2231 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2232 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2233 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2234 details on the supported keywords.
2235
2236 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2237 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2238 with the usual backslash ('\').
2239
2240 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2241 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2242 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2243 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2244 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2245
2246 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2247 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2248 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2249 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2250 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2251
2252 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2253 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2254 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2255 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2256 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2257 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2258
2259 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2260 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2261 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2262 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2263 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2264 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2265 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2266 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2267 trace).
2268
2269 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2270 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2271 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2272 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2273 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2274 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2275 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2276 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2277
2278 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2279 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2280 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2281 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2282 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2283 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2284 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2285 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2286
2287 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2288 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2289
2290 Examples :
2291 # only accept status 200 as valid
2292 http-request expect status 200
2293
2294 # consider SQL errors as errors
2295 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2296
2297 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2298 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2299
2300 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2301 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002303 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002304
2305
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002306http-check send-state
2307 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2309 yes | no | yes | yes
2310 Arguments : none
2311
2312 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2313 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2314 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2315 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2316 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2317
2318 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2319 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2320 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2321 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2322 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2323 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2324 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2325 checked in multiple backends.
2326
2327 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2328 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2329
2330 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2331 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2332 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2333 one fails.
2334
2335 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2336 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2337 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2338
2339 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2340 server's queue.
2341
2342 Example of a header received by the application server :
2343 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2344 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2345
2346 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2347
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002348http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002349 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002350 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2351
2352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2353 no | yes | yes | yes
2354
2355 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2356 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2357 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002358 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2359 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002360 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2361
2362 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2363 instance.
2364
2365 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002366 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2367 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2368 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002369
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002370 http-request allow if nagios
2371 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2372 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2373 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002374
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002375 Example:
2376 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002377
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002378 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002379
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002380 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2381 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002383id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002384 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2386 no | yes | yes | yes
2387 Arguments : none
2388
2389 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2390 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2391 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002392
2393
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002394ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2395 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 no | yes | yes | yes
2398
2399 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2400 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2401 and running).
2402
2403 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2404 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2405 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2406 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2407 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2408
2409 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2410 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2411
2412 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2413 "unless" condition is met.
2414
2415 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2416
2417
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002418log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002419log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002420 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2422 yes | yes | yes | yes
2423 Arguments :
2424 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2425 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2426 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2427 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2428 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2429 parameter.
2430
2431 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2432 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2433
2434 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2435 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2436 standard syslog port).
2437
2438 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2439 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2440 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2441 appropriately writeable).
2442
2443 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2444
2445 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2446 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2447 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2448
2449 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2450 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2451 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002452 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2453 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2454 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2455 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2456 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002457
2458 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2459
2460 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2461 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2462 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2463
2464 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002465 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2466 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2467 "info".
2468
2469 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2470 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2471 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2472 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2473
2474 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2475 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002476
2477 Example :
2478 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002479 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2480 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002481
2482
2483maxconn <conns>
2484 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2486 yes | yes | yes | no
2487 Arguments :
2488 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2489 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2490 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2491 closes.
2492
2493 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2494 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2495 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2496 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2497 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2498 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2499 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2500 properly tuned.
2501
2502 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2503 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2504 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2505
2506 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2507
2508
2509mode { tcp|http|health }
2510 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | yes
2513 Arguments :
2514 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2515 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2516 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2517 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2518
2519 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2520 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2521 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2522 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2523 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2524
2525 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2526 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2527 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2528 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2529 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2530 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2531
2532 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2533 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2534 will be refused.
2535
2536 Example :
2537 defaults http_instances
2538 mode http
2539
2540 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002543monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002544 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2546 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547 Arguments :
2548 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2549 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002550 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2552 backend and its backup.
2553
2554 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2555 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2556 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2557 servers in a list of backends.
2558
2559 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2560 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2561 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2562 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2563 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2564 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2565 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002566 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567
2568 Example:
2569 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002570 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002571 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2572 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2573 monitor-uri /site_alive
2574 monitor fail if site_dead
2575
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2577
2578
2579monitor-net <source>
2580 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | yes | yes | no
2583 Arguments :
2584 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2585 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2586 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2587 followed by a mask.
2588
2589 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2590 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002591 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002592 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2593
2594 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2595 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2596 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2597 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2598 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2599
2600 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2601 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2602 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2603 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2604 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2605
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002606 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2607 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609 Example :
2610 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2611 frontend www
2612 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2613
2614 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2615
2616
2617monitor-uri <uri>
2618 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 yes | yes | yes | no
2621 Arguments :
2622 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2623 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2624
2625 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2626 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2627 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2628 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2629 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2630 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2631 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2632 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2633
2634 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2635 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2636 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2637 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2638 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2639 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2640
2641 Example :
2642 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2643 frontend www
2644 mode http
2645 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2646
2647 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002649
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002650option abortonclose
2651no option abortonclose
2652 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 yes | no | yes | yes
2655 Arguments : none
2656
2657 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2658 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2659 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2660 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002661 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002662 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2663 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2664 encountered while delivering the response.
2665
2666 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2667 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2668 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2669 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2670 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2671 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002672 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002673 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002674 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002675 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2676 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2677 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2678
2679 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2680 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2681 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2682 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2683 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2684 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2685 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2686 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002687 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002688
2689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2691
2692 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2693
2694
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002695option accept-invalid-http-request
2696no option accept-invalid-http-request
2697 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2699 yes | yes | yes | no
2700 Arguments : none
2701
2702 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2703 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2704 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2705 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2706 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2707 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2708 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2709 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2710 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2711
2712 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2713 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2714 been confirmed.
2715
2716 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2717 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2718 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2719 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2720
2721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2723
2724 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2725 stats socket.
2726
2727
2728option accept-invalid-http-response
2729no option accept-invalid-http-response
2730 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2732 yes | no | yes | yes
2733 Arguments : none
2734
2735 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2736 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2737 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2738 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2739 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2740 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2741 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2742 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2743 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2744
2745 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2746 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2747 been confirmed.
2748
2749 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2750 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2751 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2752 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2753
2754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2756
2757 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2758 stats socket.
2759
2760
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002761option allbackups
2762no option allbackups
2763 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2765 yes | no | yes | yes
2766 Arguments : none
2767
2768 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2769 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2770 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2771 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2772 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2773 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2774 order between the backup servers anymore.
2775
2776 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2777 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2778
2779 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2780 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2781
2782
2783option checkcache
2784no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002785 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2787 yes | no | yes | yes
2788 Arguments : none
2789
2790 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2791 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002792 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002793 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2794 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2795 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2796
2797 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002798 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002799 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002800 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2801 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002802 to the client are :
2803 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002804 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002805 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002806 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2807 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2808 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2809 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2810 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2811 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2812 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2813 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2814 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2815 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2816 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2817
2818 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002819 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002820 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002821 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002822 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2823
2824 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2825 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002826 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002827 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2828
2829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2831
2832
2833option clitcpka
2834no option clitcpka
2835 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2837 yes | yes | yes | no
2838 Arguments : none
2839
2840 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2841 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2842 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2843 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2844
2845 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2846 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2847 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2848 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2849
2850 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2851 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2852 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2853 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2854 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2855
2856 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2857
2858 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2859 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2860 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2861
2862 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2863 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2864
2865 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2866
2867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868option contstats
2869 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 yes | yes | yes | no
2872 Arguments : none
2873
2874 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2875 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2876 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2877 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2878 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2879 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2880 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2881
2882
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002883option dontlog-normal
2884no option dontlog-normal
2885 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 yes | yes | yes | no
2888 Arguments : none
2889
2890 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2891 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2892 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2893 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2894 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2895 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2896 logged.
2897
2898 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2899 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2900 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002902 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002903 logging.
2904
2905
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002906option dontlognull
2907no option dontlognull
2908 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2910 yes | yes | yes | no
2911 Arguments : none
2912
2913 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2914 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2915 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2916 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2917 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2918 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2919 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2920
2921 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2922 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2923 would not be logged.
2924
2925 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2926 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002928 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002929
2930
2931option forceclose
2932no option forceclose
2933 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
2934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01002935 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002936 Arguments : none
2937
2938 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
2939 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
2940 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
2941 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
2942 global session times in the logs.
2943
2944 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01002945 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01002946 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
2947 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
2948 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
2949 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002950
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002951 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
2952 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
2953 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
2954
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002955 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2956 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2957
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002958 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002959
2960
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002961option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002962 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
2963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2964 yes | yes | yes | yes
2965 Arguments :
2966 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
2967 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002968 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002969 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002970
2971 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
2972 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
2973 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
2974 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
2975 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
2976 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
2977 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002978 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
2979 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
2980 possible that the client has already brought one.
2981
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002982 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002983 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002984 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
2985 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002986 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
2987 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002988
2989 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
2990 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
2991 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
2992 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
2993 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
2994 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
2995 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
2996
2997 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002998 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
2999 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3000 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003001
3002 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3003 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3004 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3005 when using this option.
3006
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003007 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003008 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3009 frontend www
3010 mode http
3011 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3012
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003013 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3014 backend www
3015 mode http
3016 option forwardfor header X-Client
3017
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003018 See also : "option httpclose"
3019
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003020
3021option http-pretend-keepalive
3022no option http-pretend-keepalive
3023 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3025 yes | yes | yes | yes
3026 Arguments : none
3027
3028 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3029 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3030 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3031 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3032 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3033 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3034 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3035 consider the response complete.
3036
3037 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3038 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3039 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3040 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3041 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3042 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3043
3044 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3045 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3046 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3047 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3048 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3049 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3050 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3051
3052 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3053 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003054 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3055 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3056 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003057
3058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3060
3061 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3062
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003063
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003064option http-server-close
3065no option http-server-close
3066 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 yes | yes | yes | yes
3069 Arguments : none
3070
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003071 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3072 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3073 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3074 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3075 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3076 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3077 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3078 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3079 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3080 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3081 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3082 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003083
3084 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3085 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3086 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3087 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003088 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3089 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003090
3091 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3092 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003093 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3094 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3095 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003096
3097 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3098 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3099
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003100 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3101 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003102
3103
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003104option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003105no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003106 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3108 yes | yes | yes | no
3109 Arguments : none
3110
3111 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3112 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3113 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3114 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3115 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3116 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3117 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3118
3119 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3120 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3121 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3122 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3123 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3124 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3125 request along its whole life.
3126
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003127 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3128 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3129 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3130 front of an existing proxy.
3131
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003132 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3133
3134 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3135 http-server-close".
3136
3137
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003138option httpchk
3139option httpchk <uri>
3140option httpchk <method> <uri>
3141option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3142 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3144 yes | no | yes | yes
3145 Arguments :
3146 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3147 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3148 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3149 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3150 ones.
3151
3152 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3153 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3154 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3155
3156 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3157 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3158 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3159 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3160 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3161
3162 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3163 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3164 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3165 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3166 the lack of any response.
3167
3168 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3169
3170 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3171 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3172 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3173
3174 Examples :
3175 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3176 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3177 backend https_relay
3178 mode tcp
3179 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3180 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3181
3182 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3183 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3184
3185
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003186option httpclose
3187no option httpclose
3188 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3190 yes | yes | yes | yes
3191 Arguments : none
3192
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003193 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3194 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3195 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3196 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3197 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3198 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3199 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003200
3201 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003202 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3203 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3204 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3205 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3206 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3207 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003208
3209 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3210 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3211 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003212 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3213 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003214
3215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3217
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003218 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3219 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003220
3221
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003222option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003223 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003226 Arguments :
3227 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3228 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3229 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3230 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3231 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003232
3233 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3234 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3235 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3236 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3237 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3238 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3239 ports.
3240
3241 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3242
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3245 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3246 by default.
3247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003248 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003249
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003250
3251option http_proxy
3252no option http_proxy
3253 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3255 yes | yes | yes | yes
3256 Arguments : none
3257
3258 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3259 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3260 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3261 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3262 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3263
3264 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3265 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3266 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3267 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
3268 needed to add "option http_close" to ensure that all requests will correctly
3269 be analyzed.
3270
3271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3273
3274 Example :
3275 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3276 backend direct_forward
3277 option httpclose
3278 option http_proxy
3279
3280 See also : "option httpclose"
3281
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003282
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003283option ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3284 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3286 no | yes | yes | yes
3287
3288 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3289 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3290 and running).
3291
3292 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3293 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3294 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3295 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3296 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3297
3298 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3299 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3300
3301 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3302 "unless" condition is met.
3303
3304 See also : "option force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3305
3306
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003307option independant-streams
3308no option independant-streams
3309 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3311 yes | yes | yes | yes
3312 Arguments : none
3313
3314 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3315 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3316 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3317 receive data or not.
3318
3319 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3320 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3321 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3322 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3323 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3324 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3325 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3326 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3327 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3328 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3329 socket buffers.
3330
3331 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3332 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3333 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3334 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3335 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3336
3337 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3338
3339
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003340option ldap-check
3341 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3343 yes | no | yes | yes
3344 Arguments : none
3345
3346 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3347 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3348 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3349 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3350
3351 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3352 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3353
3354 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3355 configure it.
3356
3357 Example :
3358 option ldap-check
3359
3360 See also : "option httpchk"
3361
3362
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003363option log-health-checks
3364no option log-health-checks
3365 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3367 yes | no | yes | yes
3368 Arguments : none
3369
3370 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3371 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3372 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3373 of additional information is limited.
3374
3375 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3376 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3377
3378 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3379
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003380
3381option log-separate-errors
3382no option log-separate-errors
3383 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3385 yes | yes | yes | no
3386 Arguments : none
3387
3388 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3389 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3390 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3391 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3392 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3393 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3394 provides very important information.
3395
3396 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3397 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3398 error logs.
3399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003400 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003401 logging.
3402
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003403
3404option logasap
3405no option logasap
3406 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3408 yes | yes | yes | no
3409 Arguments : none
3410
3411 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3412 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3413 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3414 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3415 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3416 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3417 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003418 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003419 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3420 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3421
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003422 Examples :
3423 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3424 mode http
3425 option httplog
3426 option logasap
3427 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3428
3429 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3430 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3431 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3432 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003434 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003435 logging.
3436
3437
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003438option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3439 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003442 Arguments :
3443 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3444 to MySQL server.
3445
3446 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3447 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3448 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3449 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3450 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3451 in the MySQL table, like this :
3452
3453 USE mysql;
3454 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3455 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3456
3457 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3458 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3459 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3460 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3461 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3462 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3463 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3464 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3465 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3466
3467 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3468 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003469
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003470 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003471
3472 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3473 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3474 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3475 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3476 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3477 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3478
3479 See also: "option httpchk"
3480
3481
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003482option nolinger
3483no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003484 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003487 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003488
3489 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3490 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3491 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3492 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3493 connections.
3494
3495 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3496 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3497 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3498 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3499 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3500 this too.
3501
3502 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3503 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3504 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3505
3506 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3507 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3508 for servers.
3509
3510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3512
3513
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003514option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3515 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3517 yes | yes | yes | yes
3518 Arguments :
3519 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3520 matching <network>
3521 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3522 header name.
3523
3524 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3525 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3526 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3527 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3528 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3529 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3530 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3531 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3532 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3533 possible that the client has already brought one.
3534
3535 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3536 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3537 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3538 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3539 header and requires different one.
3540
3541 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3542 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3543 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3544 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3545 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3546 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3547 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3548
3549 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3550 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3551 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3552 both are defined.
3553
3554 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3555 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3556 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3557 when using this option.
3558
3559 Examples :
3560 # Original Destination address
3561 frontend www
3562 mode http
3563 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3564
3565 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3566 backend www
3567 mode http
3568 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3569
3570 See also : "option httpclose"
3571
3572
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003573option persist
3574no option persist
3575 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003578 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003579
3580 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3581 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3582 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3583 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3584 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3585 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3586 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3587 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3588 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3589 redirected to another valid server.
3590
3591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3593
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003594 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003595
3596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003597option redispatch
3598no option redispatch
3599 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003602 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003603
3604 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3605 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3606 be able to access the service anymore.
3607
3608 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3609 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3610
3611 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3612 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3613 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003615 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3616 "redisp" keywords.
3617
3618 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3619 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3620
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003621 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003622
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003623
3624option smtpchk
3625option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3626 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3628 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003629 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003630 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3631 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3632 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3633
3634 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3635 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3636 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3637
3638 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3639 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3640 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3641 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3642 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3643 dead server.
3644
3645 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3646 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3647 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3648 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3649
3650 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3651 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3652 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3653 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3654 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3655
3656 Example :
3657 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3658
3659 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003662option socket-stats
3663no option socket-stats
3664
3665 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3667 yes | yes | yes | no
3668
3669 Arguments : none
3670
3671
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003672option splice-auto
3673no option splice-auto
3674 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3676 yes | yes | yes | yes
3677 Arguments : none
3678
3679 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3680 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3681 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3682 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003683 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003684 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3685 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3686 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3687 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3688
3689 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3690 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3691 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3692 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3693 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3694 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3695 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3696 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3697 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3698 keyword.
3699
3700 Example :
3701 option splice-auto
3702
3703 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3704 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3705
3706 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3707 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3708
3709
3710option splice-request
3711no option splice-request
3712 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | yes
3715 Arguments : none
3716
3717 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3718 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3719 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3720 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3721 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3722 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3723
3724 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3725
3726 Example :
3727 option splice-request
3728
3729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3731
3732 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3733 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3734
3735
3736option splice-response
3737no option splice-response
3738 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3740 yes | yes | yes | yes
3741 Arguments : none
3742
3743 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3744 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3745 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3746 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3747 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3748 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3749
3750 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3751
3752 Example :
3753 option splice-response
3754
3755 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3756 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3757
3758 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3759 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3760
3761
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003762option srvtcpka
3763no option srvtcpka
3764 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3766 yes | no | yes | yes
3767 Arguments : none
3768
3769 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3770 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3771 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3772 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3773
3774 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3775 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3776 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3777 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3778
3779 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3780 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3781 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3782 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3783 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3784
3785 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3786
3787 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3788 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3789 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3790
3791 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3792 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3793
3794 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3795
3796
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003797option ssl-hello-chk
3798 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3800 yes | no | yes | yes
3801 Arguments : none
3802
3803 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3804 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3805 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3806 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3807 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3808 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3809 hello message.
3810
3811 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3812 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3813 messages, which is appreciable.
3814
3815 See also: "option httpchk"
3816
3817
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003818option tcp-smart-accept
3819no option tcp-smart-accept
3820 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3822 yes | yes | yes | no
3823 Arguments : none
3824
3825 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3826 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3827 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3828 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3829 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3830 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3831
3832 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3833 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3834 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3835 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3836
3837 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3838 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3839 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3840 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3841
3842 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3843 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3844 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3845
3846 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3847 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3848 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3849
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003850 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3851
3852
3853option tcp-smart-connect
3854no option tcp-smart-connect
3855 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3857 yes | no | yes | yes
3858 Arguments : none
3859
3860 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3861 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3862 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3863 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3864 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3865
3866 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3867 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3868 complex.
3869
3870 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3871 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3872 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3873
3874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3876
3877 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3878
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003879
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003880option tcpka
3881 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3883 yes | yes | yes | yes
3884 Arguments : none
3885
3886 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3887 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3888 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3889 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3890
3891 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3892 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3893 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3894 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3895
3896 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3897 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3898 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3899 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3900 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3901
3902 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3903
3904 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3905 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3906 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3907 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3908 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3909 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3910 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3911 backends.
3912
3913 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3914
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003915
3916option tcplog
3917 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3919 yes | yes | yes | yes
3920 Arguments : none
3921
3922 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3923 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3924 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3925 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3926 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3927 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3928 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3929 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3930
3931 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3932
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003933 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003934
3935
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003936option transparent
3937no option transparent
3938 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003940 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003941 Arguments : none
3942
3943 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3944 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3945 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
3946 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
3947 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
3948 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
3949 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
3950 appropriate server.
3951
3952 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
3953 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
3954
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003955 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
3956 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003957
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003958
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003959persist rdp-cookie
3960persist rdp-cookie(name)
3961 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
3962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3963 yes | no | yes | yes
3964 Arguments :
3965 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003966 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
3967 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003968
3969 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
3970 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
3971 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
3972 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
3973 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
3974 forwarded to this server.
3975
3976 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
3977 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
3978 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003979 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003980 a single "listen" section.
3981
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003982 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
3983 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
3984 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
3985
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003986 Example :
3987 listen tse-farm
3988 bind :3389
3989 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
3990 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
3991 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
3992 # apply RDP cookie persistence
3993 persist rdp-cookie
3994 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
3995 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
3996 balance rdp-cookie
3997 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
3998 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
3999
4000 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4001
4002
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004003rate-limit sessions <rate>
4004 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4006 yes | yes | yes | no
4007 Arguments :
4008 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4009 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4010
4011 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4012 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4013 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4014 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4015 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4016 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4017
4018 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4019 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4020 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4021 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4022
4023 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4024 listen smtp
4025 mode tcp
4026 bind :25
4027 rate-limit sessions 10
4028 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4029
4030 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4031 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4032
4033 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4034
4035
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004036redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4037redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004038 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4040 no | yes | yes | yes
4041
4042 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004043 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004044
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004045 Arguments :
4046 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4047 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4048 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4049 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004050 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4051 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4052 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4053 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004054
4055 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4056 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4057 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4058 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4059 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4060 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4061 location with a GET method.
4062
4063 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4064 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4065
4066 - "drop-query"
4067 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4068 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4069 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4070 with a location-type redirect.
4071
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004072 - "append-slash"
4073 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4074 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4075 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4076 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4077
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004078 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4079 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4080 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4081 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4082 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4083 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4084 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4085
4086 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4087 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4088 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4089 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4090 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4091 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4092 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004093
4094 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4095 acl clear dst_port 80
4096 acl secure dst_port 8080
4097 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004098 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004099 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004100 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4101
4102 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004103 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4104 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4105 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004106 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004107
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004108 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4109 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4110 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004113
4114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004115redisp (deprecated)
4116redispatch (deprecated)
4117 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4118 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004120 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004121
4122 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4123 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4124 be able to access the service anymore.
4125
4126 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4127 redistribute them to a working server.
4128
4129 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4130 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4131 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004133 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4134 "option redispatch" instead.
4135
4136 See also : "option redispatch"
4137
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004138
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004139reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004140 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 no | yes | yes | yes
4143 Arguments :
4144 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4145 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004146 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004147
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004148 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4149 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4150
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004151 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4152 the last header of an HTTP request.
4153
4154 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4155 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4156 responses.
4157
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004158 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4159 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4160 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4161
4162 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4163 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004164
4165
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004166reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4167reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004168 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 no | yes | yes | yes
4171 Arguments :
4172 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4173 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4174 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4175 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4176 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4177 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4178 ignores case.
4179
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004180 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4181 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4182
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004183 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4184 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4185 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4186 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004187 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004188
4189 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4190 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4191
4192 Example :
4193 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4194 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4195 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4196
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004197 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4198 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004199
4200
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004201reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4202reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004203 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 no | yes | yes | yes
4206 Arguments :
4207 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4208 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4209 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4210 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4211 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4212 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4213
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004214 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4215 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4216
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004217 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4218 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4219 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4220 next servers.
4221
4222 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4223 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4224 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4225
4226 Example :
4227 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4228 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4229 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4230
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004231 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4232 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004233
4234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004235reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4236reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004237 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4239 no | yes | yes | yes
4240 Arguments :
4241 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4242 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4243 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4244 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4245 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4246 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4247 case.
4248
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004249 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4250 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4251
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004252 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4253 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4254 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4255 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004256 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004257
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004258 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004259 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004260 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004261
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004262 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4263 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4264
4265 Example :
4266 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4267 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4268 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4269
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004270 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4271 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004272
4273
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004274reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4275reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004276 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 no | yes | yes | yes
4279 Arguments :
4280 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4281 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4282 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4283 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4284 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4285 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4286 case.
4287
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004288 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4289 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4290
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004291 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4292 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4293 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4294 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4295
4296 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4297 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4298
4299 Example :
4300 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4301 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4302 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4303 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4304
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004305 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4306 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004307
4308
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004309reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4310reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004311 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 no | yes | yes | yes
4314 Arguments :
4315 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4316 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4317 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4318 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4319 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4320 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4321
4322 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4323 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4324 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4325 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004326 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004327
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004328 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4329 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4330
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004331 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4332 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4333 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4334
4335 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4336 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4337 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4338 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4339 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4340
4341 Example :
4342 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4343 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4344 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4345 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4346
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004347 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4348 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004349
4350
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004351reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4352reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004353 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4355 no | yes | yes | yes
4356 Arguments :
4357 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4358 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4359 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4360 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4361 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4362 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4363 ignores case.
4364
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004365 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4366 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4367
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004368 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4369 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004370 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4371 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4372 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004373 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4374 not set.
4375
4376 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4377 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4378 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4379 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4380 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4381
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004382 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004383 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4384 # block all others.
4385 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4386 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004388 # block bad guys
4389 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4390 reqitarpit . if badguys
4391
4392 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4393 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004394
4395
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004396retries <value>
4397 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 yes | no | yes | yes
4400 Arguments :
4401 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4402 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4403 default value is 3.
4404
4405 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4406 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4407 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4408
4409 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4410 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4411
4412 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4413 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4414
4415 See also : "option redispatch"
4416
4417
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004418rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004419 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4421 no | yes | yes | yes
4422 Arguments :
4423 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4424 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004425 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004426
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004427 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4428 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4429
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004430 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4431 the last header of an HTTP response.
4432
4433 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4434 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4435 responses.
4436
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004437 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4438 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004439
4440
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004441rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4442rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004443 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4445 no | yes | yes | yes
4446 Arguments :
4447 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4448 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4449 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4450 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4451 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4452 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4453 ignores case.
4454
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004455 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4456 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4457
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004458 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4459 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4460 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4461 client.
4462
4463 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4464 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4465 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4466
4467 Example :
4468 # remove the Server header from responses
4469 reqidel ^Server:.*
4470
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004471 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4472 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004473
4474
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004475rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4476rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004477 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4479 no | yes | yes | yes
4480 Arguments :
4481 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4482 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4483 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4484 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4485 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4486 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4487 ignores case.
4488
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004489 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4490 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004492 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4493 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4494 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4495 case-sensitive.
4496
4497 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004498 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4499 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4500 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004501
4502 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4503 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4504
4505 Example :
4506 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4507 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4508
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004509 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4510 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004511
4512
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004513rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4514rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004515 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4517 no | yes | yes | yes
4518 Arguments :
4519 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4520 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4521 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4522 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4523 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4524 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4525 ignores case.
4526
4527 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4528 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4529 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4530 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004531 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004532
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004533 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4534 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4535
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004536 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4537 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4538 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4539
4540 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4541 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4542 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4543 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4544 are not case-sensitive.
4545
4546 Example :
4547 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4548 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4549
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004550 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4551 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552
4553
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004554server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4555 Declare a server in a backend
4556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4557 no | no | yes | yes
4558 Arguments :
4559 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4560 appear in logs and alerts.
4561
4562 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4563 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004564 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4565 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4566 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4567 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4568 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4569 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4570 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4571 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004572
4573 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4574 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4575 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4576 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4577 adding this value to the client's port.
4578
4579 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4580 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004581 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004582
4583 Examples :
4584 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4585 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004587 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004588
4589
4590source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004591source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004592source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004593 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | no | yes | yes
4596 Arguments :
4597 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4598 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4599 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4600 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4601
4602 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4603 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004604 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4605 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4606 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004607
4608 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4609 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4610 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4611 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4612 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4613 <addr>.
4614
4615 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4616 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4617 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4618 port.
4619
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004620 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4621 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4622 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4623 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4624 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4625 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4626 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4627 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4628 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4629 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4630 HTTP header.
4631
4632 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4633 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4634 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4635 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4636 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4637 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4638 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4639 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4640 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4641 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4642
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004643 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4644 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4645 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4646 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4647 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4648 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4649
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004650 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4651 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4652 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4653 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4654
4655 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4656 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4657 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4658 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4659 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4660 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4661
4662 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4663 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4664 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4665 there are two methods :
4666
4667 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4668 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4669 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4670 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4671 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4672 of the client ranges may be used.
4673
4674 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4675 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4676 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4677 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4678 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4679 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4680 same session.
4681
4682 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4683 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4684 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4685 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4686 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4687 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4688
4689 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4690 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4691 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004692 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004693
4694 Examples :
4695 backend private
4696 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4697 source 192.168.1.200
4698
4699 backend transparent_ssl1
4700 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4701 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4702
4703 backend transparent_ssl2
4704 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4705 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4706 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4707
4708 backend transparent_ssl3
4709 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4710 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4711 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4712
4713 backend transparent_smtp
4714 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4715 # with Tproxy version 4.
4716 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4717
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004718 backend transparent_http
4719 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4720 # proxy.
4721 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004723 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004724 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004726
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004727srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4728 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 yes | no | yes | yes
4731 Arguments :
4732 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4733 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4734 as explained at the top of this document.
4735
4736 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4737 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4738 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4739 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4740 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4741 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4742 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4743
4744 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4745 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4746 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4747 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4748 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004749 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004750 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004751 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004752
4753 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4754 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4755 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4756 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4757 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4758 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4759
4760 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4761 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4762
4763 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4764
4765
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004766stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4767 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4769 no | no | yes | yes
4770
4771 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4772 matched.
4773
4774 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4775 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4776
4777 Currently, there are 2 known limitations :
4778
4779 - The POST data are limited to one packet, which means that if the list of
4780 servers is too long, the request won't be processed. It is recommended
4781 to alter few servers at a time.
4782
4783 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported.
4784
4785 Example :
4786 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4787 backend stats_localhost
4788 stats enable
4789 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4790
4791 Example :
4792 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4793 backend stats_auth
4794 stats enable
4795 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4796 stats admin if TRUE
4797
4798 Example :
4799 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4800 userlist stats-auth
4801 group admin users admin
4802 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4803 group readonly users haproxy
4804 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4805
4806 backend stats_auth
4807 stats enable
4808 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4809 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4810 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4811 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4812
4813 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
4814 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
4815
4816
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004817stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4818 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4820 yes | no | yes | yes
4821 Arguments :
4822 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4823
4824 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4825
4826 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4827 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4828 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4829 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4830 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4831 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4832
4833 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4834 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4835 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4836 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4837
4838 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4839 report using "stats scope".
4840
4841 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4842 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4843 unobvious parameters.
4844
4845 Example :
4846 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4847 backend public_www
4848 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4849 stats enable
4850 stats hide-version
4851 stats scope .
4852 stats uri /admin?stats
4853 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4854 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4855 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4856
4857 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4858 backend private_monitoring
4859 stats enable
4860 stats uri /admin?stats
4861 stats refresh 5s
4862
4863 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4864
4865
4866stats enable
4867 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4869 yes | no | yes | yes
4870 Arguments : none
4871
4872 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4873 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4874 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4875 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4876 - stats auth : no authentication
4877 - stats scope : no restriction
4878
4879 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4880 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4881 unobvious parameters.
4882
4883 Example :
4884 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4885 backend public_www
4886 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4887 stats enable
4888 stats hide-version
4889 stats scope .
4890 stats uri /admin?stats
4891 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4892 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4893 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4894
4895 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4896 backend private_monitoring
4897 stats enable
4898 stats uri /admin?stats
4899 stats refresh 5s
4900
4901 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4902
4903
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004904stats hide-version
4905 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004908 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004909
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004910 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4911 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4912 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4913 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4914 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4915 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004916
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004917 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4918 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4919 unobvious parameters.
4920
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004921 Example :
4922 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4923 backend public_www
4924 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004925 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004926 stats hide-version
4927 stats scope .
4928 stats uri /admin?stats
4929 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4930 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4931 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004932
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004933 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4934 backend private_monitoring
4935 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004936 stats uri /admin?stats
4937 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004939 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004940
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004941
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004942stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
4943 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4944 Access control for statistics
4945
4946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4947 no | no | yes | yes
4948
4949 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
4950 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
4951 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
4952 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
4953 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
4954 should be asked to enter a username and password.
4955
4956 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
4957 instance.
4958
4959 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4960 about ACL usage.
4961
4962
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004963stats realm <realm>
4964 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
4965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | no | yes | yes
4967 Arguments :
4968 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
4969 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
4970 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
4971
4972 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
4973 using a backslash ('\').
4974
4975 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
4976 only related to authentication.
4977
4978 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4979 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4980 unobvious parameters.
4981
4982 Example :
4983 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4984 backend public_www
4985 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4986 stats enable
4987 stats hide-version
4988 stats scope .
4989 stats uri /admin?stats
4990 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4991 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4992 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4993
4994 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4995 backend private_monitoring
4996 stats enable
4997 stats uri /admin?stats
4998 stats refresh 5s
4999
5000 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5001
5002
5003stats refresh <delay>
5004 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | no | yes | yes
5007 Arguments :
5008 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5009 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5010 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5011 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5012 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5013 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5014
5015 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5016 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5017 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5018 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5019
5020 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5021 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5022 unobvious parameters.
5023
5024 Example :
5025 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5026 backend public_www
5027 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5028 stats enable
5029 stats hide-version
5030 stats scope .
5031 stats uri /admin?stats
5032 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5033 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5034 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5035
5036 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5037 backend private_monitoring
5038 stats enable
5039 stats uri /admin?stats
5040 stats refresh 5s
5041
5042 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5043
5044
5045stats scope { <name> | "." }
5046 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 yes | no | yes | yes
5049 Arguments :
5050 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5051 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5052 section in which the statement appears.
5053
5054 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5055 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5056 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5057 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5058 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5059 exists.
5060
5061 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5062 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5063 unobvious parameters.
5064
5065 Example :
5066 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5067 backend public_www
5068 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5069 stats enable
5070 stats hide-version
5071 stats scope .
5072 stats uri /admin?stats
5073 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5074 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5075 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5076
5077 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5078 backend private_monitoring
5079 stats enable
5080 stats uri /admin?stats
5081 stats refresh 5s
5082
5083 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5084
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005085
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005086stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005087 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5089 yes | no | yes | yes
5090
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005091 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005092 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5093
5094 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5095 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5096
5097 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5098 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5099 unobvious parameters.
5100
5101 Example :
5102 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5103 backend private_monitoring
5104 stats enable
5105 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5106 stats uri /admin?stats
5107 stats refresh 5s
5108
5109 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5110 global section.
5111
5112
5113stats show-legends
5114 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5115 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5116 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5117 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5118 - IP (socket, server)
5119 - cookie (backend, server)
5120
5121 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5122 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5123 unobvious parameters.
5124
5125 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5126
5127
5128stats show-node [ <name> ]
5129 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5131 yes | no | yes | yes
5132 Arguments:
5133 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5134 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5135
5136 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5137 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5138 provided for each customer.
5139
5140 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5141 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5142 unobvious parameters.
5143
5144 Example:
5145 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5146 backend private_monitoring
5147 stats enable
5148 stats show-node Europe-1
5149 stats uri /admin?stats
5150 stats refresh 5s
5151
5152 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5153 section.
5154
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005155
5156stats uri <prefix>
5157 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5159 yes | no | yes | yes
5160 Arguments :
5161 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5162 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5163 query string.
5164
5165 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5166 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5167 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5168 possible to reach it in the application.
5169
5170 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005171 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005172 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5173 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5174 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5175 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5176
5177 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5178 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5179 an address or a port to statistics only.
5180
5181 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5182 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5183 unobvious parameters.
5184
5185 Example :
5186 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5187 backend public_www
5188 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5189 stats enable
5190 stats hide-version
5191 stats scope .
5192 stats uri /admin?stats
5193 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5194 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5195 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5196
5197 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5198 backend private_monitoring
5199 stats enable
5200 stats uri /admin?stats
5201 stats refresh 5s
5202
5203 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5204
5205
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005206stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5207 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005209 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005210
5211 Arguments :
5212 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5213 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5214 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5215 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5216
5217 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5218 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5219 the "stick-table" statement.
5220
5221 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5222 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5223 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5224 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5225 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5226
5227 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5228 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5229 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5230 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5231 transformation rules.
5232
5233 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5234 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5235 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5236 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5237 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5238 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5239 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5240
5241 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5242 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5243 ACL based conditions.
5244
5245 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5246 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5247 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5248 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5249
5250 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5251 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5252 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5253 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5254
5255 Example :
5256 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5257 # last 30 minutes
5258 backend pop
5259 mode tcp
5260 balance roundrobin
5261 stick store-request src
5262 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5263 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5264 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5265
5266 backend smtp
5267 mode tcp
5268 balance roundrobin
5269 stick match src table pop
5270 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5271 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5272
5273 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5274 extraction.
5275
5276
5277stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5278 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5280 no | no | yes | yes
5281
5282 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5283 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5284 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5285 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5286
5287 Examples :
5288 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005289 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005290
5291 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5292 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5293 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5294
5295
5296 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5297 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5298 backend http
5299 mode http
5300 balance roundrobin
5301 stick on src table https
5302 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5303 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5304 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5305
5306 backend https
5307 mode tcp
5308 balance roundrobin
5309 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5310 stick on src
5311 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5312 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5313
5314 See also : "stick match" and "stick store-request"
5315
5316
5317stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5318 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 no | no | yes | yes
5321
5322 Arguments :
5323 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5324 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5325 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5326 server is selected.
5327
5328 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5329 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5330 the "stick-table" statement.
5331
5332 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5333 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5334 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5335 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5336 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5337 address.
5338
5339 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5340 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5341 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5342 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5343 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5344 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5345 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5346 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5347 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5348 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5349
5350 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5351 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5352 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5353 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5354 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5355 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5356 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5357
5358 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5359 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5360 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5361 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5362
5363 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5364 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5365 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5366 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5367 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5368 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5369 another protocol or access method.
5370
5371 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5372 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5373 the request.
5374
5375 Example :
5376 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5377 # last 30 minutes
5378 backend pop
5379 mode tcp
5380 balance roundrobin
5381 stick store-request src
5382 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5383 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5384 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5385
5386 backend smtp
5387 mode tcp
5388 balance roundrobin
5389 stick match src table pop
5390 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5391 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5392
5393 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5394 extraction.
5395
5396
5397stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] } size <size>
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005398 [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005399 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005401 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005402
5403 Arguments :
5404 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5405 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5406 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5407 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5408
5409 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5410 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5411 instance.
5412
5413 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5414 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5415 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5416 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5417 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5418 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
5419 to 31 characters.
5420
5421 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
5422 "string" type table. See type "string" above. Be careful when
5423 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5424 increase.
5425
5426 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005427 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5428 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5429 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005430
5431 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5432 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5433 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5434 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5435 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5436 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5437 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5438 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5439 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5440 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5441 parameter (see below).
5442
5443 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5444 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5445 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5446 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5447 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5448 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5449 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5450 if not expiration delay is specified.
5451
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005452 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5453 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5454 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5455 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005456 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5457 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5458 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5459 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5460 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5461 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5462 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5463 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5464 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5465 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5466 types and their arguments.
5467
5468 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5469 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5470 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5471 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5472
5473 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5474 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5475 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5476 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5477
5478 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5479 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5480 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5481 they were received.
5482
5483 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5484 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5485 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5486 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5487 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5488
5489 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5490 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5491 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5492 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5493 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5494
5495 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5496 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5497 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5498
5499 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5500 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5501 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5502 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5503 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5504
5505 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5506 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5507 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5508 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5509 the client side.
5510
5511 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5512 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5513 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5514 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5515 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5516 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5517 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5518
5519 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5520 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5521 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5522 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5523 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5524 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5525 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5526
5527 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5528 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5529 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5530 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5531 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5532 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5533
5534 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5535 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5536 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5537 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5538
5539 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5540 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5541 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5542 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5543 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5544 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5545 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5546 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5547 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5548 recommended for better fairness.
5549
5550 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5551 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5552 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5553 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5554
5555 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5556 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5557 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5558 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5559 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5560 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5561 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5562 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5563 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5564 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005565
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005566 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5567 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005568 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5569 reference it.
5570
5571 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5572 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5573 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5574 as an exclusive stickiness.
5575
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005576 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5577 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5578 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5579 something that can be ignored.
5580
5581 Example:
5582 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5583 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5584 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5585 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5586
5587 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5588 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005589
5590
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005591tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5592 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005595 Arguments :
5596 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5597 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5598 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005600 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005601
5602 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5603 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005604 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5605 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5606 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5607 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5608 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5609 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005610
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005611 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5612 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5613 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5614 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005615
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005616 Three types of actions are supported :
5617 - accept :
5618 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5619 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5620 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005622 - reject :
5623 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5624 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5625 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5626 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5627 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5628 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5629 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5630 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5631 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5632 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5633 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5634 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005636 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5637 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5638 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5639 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5640 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5641 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5642 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5643 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5644 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005646 These actions take one or two arguments :
5647 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5648 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5649 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005650
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005651 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5652 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5653 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5654 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005655
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005656 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5657 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5658 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5659 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5660 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5661 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5662 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5663 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5664 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5665 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005666
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005667 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5668 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5669 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005670
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005671 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5672 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5673 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005674
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005675 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005676 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005677 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005678
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005679 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5680 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5681 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005682
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005683 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5684 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5685 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005686
5687 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005689 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005690
5691
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005692tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5693 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005695 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005696 Arguments :
5697 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5698 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5699 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005700
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005701 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005702
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005703 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5704 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5705 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5706 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5707 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005709 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5710 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5711 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5712 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5713 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5714 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5715 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5716 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5717 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005719 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5720 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5721 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5722 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005724 Three types of actions are supported :
5725 - accept :
5726 - reject :
5727 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005729 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5730 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005732 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5733 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5734 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5735 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5736 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5737 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005739 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005740 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5741 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005742
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005743 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5744 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5745 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5746 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5747 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005748
5749 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005750 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5751 # and reject everything else.
5752 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5753 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5754 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5755 tcp-request content reject
5756
5757 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005758 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5759 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5760 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005761 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005762
5763 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5764 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5765 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005766 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005767 tcp-request content reject
5768
5769 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5770 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5771
5772 frontend http
5773 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5774 # protecting all our sites
5775 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5776 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5777 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5778 ...
5779 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5780
5781 backend http_dynamic
5782 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5783 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5784 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5785 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5786 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5787 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5788 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005790 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005791
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005792 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005793
5794
5795tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5796 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005798 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005799 Arguments :
5800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5802 as explained at the top of this document.
5803
5804 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5805 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5806 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5807 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5808 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5809
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005810 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5811 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5812 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5813 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5814
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005815 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5816 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005817 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005818 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005819 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5820 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5821 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5822 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005823
5824 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5825 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5826 it pass through unaffected.
5827
5828 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5829 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5830 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005831 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005832 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5833 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02005834 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
5835 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
5836 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005837
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005838 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005839 "timeout client".
5840
5841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005842timeout check <timeout>
5843 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
5844 established.
5845
5846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 yes | no | yes | yes
5848 Arguments:
5849 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5850 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5851 as explained at the top of this document.
5852
5853 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
5854 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
5855 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
5856 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01005857 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
5858 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
5859 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005860
5861 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
5862 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
5863
5864 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
5865 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005866 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005867
5868 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5869 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5870 forget about it.
5871
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005872 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
5873 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005874
5875
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005876timeout client <timeout>
5877timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5878 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
5879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5880 yes | yes | yes | no
5881 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005882 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005883 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5884 as explained at the top of this document.
5885
5886 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
5887 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5888 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
5889 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
5890 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
5891 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
5892 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
5893 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005894 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005895 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
5896 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
5897
5898 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
5899 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5900 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5901 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5902 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5903 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5904
5905 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
5906 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
5907 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5908
5909 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
5910
5911
5912timeout connect <timeout>
5913timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5914 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5916 yes | no | yes | yes
5917 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5920 as explained at the top of this document.
5921
5922 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005923 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005924 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005925 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005926 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
5927 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005928
5929 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5930 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5931 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5932 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5933 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
5934 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5935
5936 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
5937 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
5938 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5939
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005940 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
5941 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005942
5943
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005944timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
5945 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
5946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | yes | yes | yes
5948 Arguments :
5949 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5950 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5951 as explained at the top of this document.
5952
5953 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
5954 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
5955 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
5956 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
5957 once the request has started to present itself.
5958
5959 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
5960 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
5961 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
5962 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
5963 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
5964
5965 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
5966 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
5967 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
5968 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
5969
5970 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
5971 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
5972 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
5973 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
5974 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02005975 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005976
5977 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
5978 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
5979 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
5980 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
5981
5982 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
5983
5984
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005985timeout http-request <timeout>
5986 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
5987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005988 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005989 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005990 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005991 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5992 as explained at the top of this document.
5993
5994 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
5995 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
5996 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
5997 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
5998 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
5999 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6000 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6001 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6002
6003 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6004 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006005 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6006 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006007
6008 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6009 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6010 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6011 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6012 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6013
6014 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006015 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6016 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6017 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006018
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006019 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006020
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006021
6022timeout queue <timeout>
6023 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6025 yes | no | yes | yes
6026 Arguments :
6027 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6028 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6029 as explained at the top of this document.
6030
6031 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6032 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6033 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6034 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6035 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6036
6037 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6038 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6039 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6040 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6041
6042 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6043
6044
6045timeout server <timeout>
6046timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6047 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6049 yes | no | yes | yes
6050 Arguments :
6051 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6053 as explained at the top of this document.
6054
6055 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6056 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6057 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6058 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6059 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6060 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6061 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6062
6063 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6064 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6065 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6066 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6067 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006068 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006069 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006070 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006071
6072 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6073 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6074 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6075 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6076 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6077 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6078
6079 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6080 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6081 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6082
6083 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6084
6085
6086timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006087 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6089 yes | yes | yes | yes
6090 Arguments :
6091 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6092 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6093 as explained at the top of this document.
6094
6095 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6096 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6097 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6098
6099 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6100 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6101 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6102 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006103 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006104
6105 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6106
6107
6108transparent (deprecated)
6109 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006111 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006112 Arguments : none
6113
6114 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6115 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6116 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6117 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6118 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6119 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6120 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6121 appropriate server.
6122
6123 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6124
6125 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6126 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6127
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006128 See also: "option transparent"
6129
6130
6131use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6132use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006133 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6135 no | yes | yes | no
6136 Arguments :
6137 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006139 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006140
6141 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6142 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6143 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006144 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6145 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6146 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6147 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006148
6149 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6150 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6151 assign the backend.
6152
6153 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6154 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6155 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6156 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6157 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6158 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6159
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006160 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006161 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006162 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6163 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6164 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6165
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006166 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006167
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010061695. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006170------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006172The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6173which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6174arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6175settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6176after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6177Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6178address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006180 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006181 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006183The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006185addr <ipv4>
6186 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6187 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6188 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6189 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6190 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006192 Supported in default-server: No
6193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006194backup
6195 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6196 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6197 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6198 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6199 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6200 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006202 Supported in default-server: No
6203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006204check
6205 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6206 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6207 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6208 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6209 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6210 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6211 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6212 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6213 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006214 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6215 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006217 Supported in default-server: No
6218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006219cookie <value>
6220 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6221 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6222 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6223 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6224 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6225 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6226 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006228 Supported in default-server: No
6229
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006230disabled
6231 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6232 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6233 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6234 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6235 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6236
6237 Supported in default-server: No
6238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006239error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006240 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6241 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6242 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006244 Supported in default-server: Yes
6245
6246 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006248fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006249 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6250 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6251 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006253 Supported in default-server: Yes
6254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006255id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006256 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6257 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6258 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006260 Supported in default-server: No
6261
6262inter <delay>
6263fastinter <delay>
6264downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006265 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6266 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6267 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6268 between checks depending on the server state :
6269
6270 Server state | Interval used
6271 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6272 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6273 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6274 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6275 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6276 or yet unchecked. |
6277 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6278 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6279 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006281 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6282 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6283 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6284 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6285 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6286 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6287 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6288 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6289 servers.
6290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006291 Supported in default-server: Yes
6292
6293maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006294 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6295 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6296 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6297 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6298 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6299 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6300 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6301 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006303 Supported in default-server: Yes
6304
6305maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006306 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6307 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6308 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6309 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6310 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6311 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6312 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006314 Supported in default-server: Yes
6315
6316minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006317 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6318 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6319 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6320 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6321 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6322 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006323 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006324 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006326 Supported in default-server: Yes
6327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006328observe <mode>
6329 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6330 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6331 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6332 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6333 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6334 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6335 headers, a timeout, etc.
6336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006337 Supported in default-server: No
6338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006339 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006341on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006342 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6343 Currently, four modes are available:
6344 - fastinter: force fastinter
6345 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6346 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6347 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6348 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006350 Supported in default-server: Yes
6351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006352 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006354port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006355 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6356 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6357 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6358 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6359 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6360 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006362 Supported in default-server: Yes
6363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006364redir <prefix>
6365 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6366 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6367 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6368 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6369 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6370 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6371 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6372 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006373 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006374 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6375 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6376 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6377 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6378 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6379
6380 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006382 Supported in default-server: No
6383
6384rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006385 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6386 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6387 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006389 Supported in default-server: Yes
6390
6391slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006392 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6393 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6394 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6395 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6396 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6397 parameters :
6398
6399 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6400 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6401
6402 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6403 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6404 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6405 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6406
6407 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6408 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6409 seen as failed.
6410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006411 Supported in default-server: Yes
6412
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006413source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006414source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006415source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006416 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6417 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6418 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6419 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6420
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006421 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6422 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6423 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6424 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6425 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6426 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6427 server.
6428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006429 Supported in default-server: No
6430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006431track [<proxy>/]<server>
6432 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6433 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6434 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6435 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6436 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006438 Supported in default-server: No
6439
6440weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006441 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6442 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6443 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006444 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6445 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6446 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6447 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6448 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6449 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006451 Supported in default-server: Yes
6452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006453
64546. HTTP header manipulation
6455---------------------------
6456
6457In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6458response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6459request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6460which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6461against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6462to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6463passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6464headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6465never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6466
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006467There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6468(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6469rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6470messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6471in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006472happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006473add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6474normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006476This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6477in section 4.2 :
6478
6479 - reqadd <string>
6480 - reqallow <search>
6481 - reqiallow <search>
6482 - reqdel <search>
6483 - reqidel <search>
6484 - reqdeny <search>
6485 - reqideny <search>
6486 - reqpass <search>
6487 - reqipass <search>
6488 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6489 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6490 - reqtarpit <search>
6491 - reqitarpit <search>
6492 - rspadd <string>
6493 - rspdel <search>
6494 - rspidel <search>
6495 - rspdeny <search>
6496 - rspideny <search>
6497 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6498 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6499
6500With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6501is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6502parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6503prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6504Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6505
6506 \t for a tab
6507 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6508 \n for a new line (LF)
6509 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6510 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6511 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6512 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6513 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6514
6515The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6516portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6517above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6518regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
65199 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6520is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6521
6522The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6523after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6524
6525Notes related to these keywords :
6526---------------------------------
6527 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6528 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6529 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6530
6531 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6532 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6533 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6534
6535 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6536 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6537 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6538 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6539 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6540
6541 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6542 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6543 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6544 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6545 useless headers before adding new ones.
6546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006547 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006548 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6549
6550 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6551 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6552 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6553
6554 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6555 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006556 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006557
6558
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010065597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6560------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006561
6562The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6563content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6564from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6565simple :
6566
6567 - define test criteria with sets of values
6568 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6569
6570The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6571
6572In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6573
6574 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6575
6576This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6577Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6578and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6579an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6580of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6581
6582ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6583'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6584which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6585
6586There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6587performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6588
6589The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6590
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006591 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6592 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006593 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6594
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006595The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6596specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6597possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006598multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6599be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6600needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6601space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6602match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6603lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6604duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6605to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6606instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006607
6608 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6609
6610In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6611the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6612case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6613too.
6614
6615Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6616a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6617ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006619Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006620
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006621 - integers or integer ranges
6622 - strings
6623 - regular expressions
6624 - IP addresses and networks
6625
6626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066277.1. Matching integers
6628----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006629
6630Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6631that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6632expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6633may be omitted.
6634
6635For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6636unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6637representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6638
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006639As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6640two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6641instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6642ranges and operators.
6643
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006644For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006645operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6646Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6647of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006649Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006650
6651 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6652 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6653 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6654 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6655 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006657For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006658
6659 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6660
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006661This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6662
6663 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6664
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066667.2. Matching strings
6667---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006668
6669String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6670exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6671characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6672string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6673to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006674before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006675
6676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066777.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6678-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006679
6680Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6681they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6682possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6683passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6684the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006685the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6686match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006687
6688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066897.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6690----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006691
6692IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6693netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6694within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006695host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006696difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6697at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6698does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6699parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006700
6701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067027.5. Available matching criteria
6703--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067057.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6706------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006707
6708A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6709analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6710addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006712always_false
6713 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6714 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6715
6716always_true
6717 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6718 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6719
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006720avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006721avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006722 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6723 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6724 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6725 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6726 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6727 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6728 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6729 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6730 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6731 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6732 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006733
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006734be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006735be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006736 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6737 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6738 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6739 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6740 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006741
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006742be_sess_rate <integer>
6743be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6744 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6745 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6746 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6747 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6748 sucking of an online dictionary).
6749
6750 Example :
6751 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6752 backend dynamic
6753 mode http
6754 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6755 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006756
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006757connslots <integer>
6758connslots(backend) <integer>
6759 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006760 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006761 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6762
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006763 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6764 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006765
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006766 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006767 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6768 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
6769 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
6770 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
6771 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006772 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006773
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006774 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
6775 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
6776 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
6777 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006778
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006779dst <ip_address>
6780 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
6781 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006782
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006783dst_conn <integer>
6784 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
6785 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
6786 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
6787 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
6788 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
6789 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
6790
6791dst_port <integer>
6792 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
6793 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
6794
6795fe_conn <integer>
6796fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
6797 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
6798 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
6799 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6800 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
6801 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
6802 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
6803 criteria.
6804
6805fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006806 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006807 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006808
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006809fe_sess_rate <integer>
6810fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
6811 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
6812 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
6813 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
6814 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
6815 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
6816 the rate to go down below the limit.
6817
6818 Example :
6819 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
6820 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
6821 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
6822 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
6823 frontend mail
6824 bind :25
6825 mode tcp
6826 maxconn 100
6827 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
6828 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
6829 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
6830 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006831
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006832nbsrv <integer>
6833nbsrv(backend) <integer>
6834 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
6835 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
6836 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
6837 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
6838 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006839
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006840queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02006841queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006842 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
6843 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
6844 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
6845 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
6846 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
6847 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
6848 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
6849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006850sc1_bytes_in_rate
6851sc2_bytes_in_rate
6852 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
6853 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6854 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
6855
6856sc1_bytes_out_rate
6857sc2_bytes_out_rate
6858 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
6859 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6860 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
6861
6862sc1_conn_cnt
6863sc2_conn_cnt
6864 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
6865 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
6866
6867sc1_conn_cur
6868sc2_conn_cur
6869 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
6870 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
6871 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
6872
6873sc1_conn_rate
6874sc2_conn_rate
6875 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
6876 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
6877 See also src_conn_rate.
6878
6879sc1_get_gpc0
6880sc2_get_gpc0
6881 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6882 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
6883
6884sc1_http_err_cnt
6885sc2_http_err_cnt
6886 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
6887 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
6888 See also src_http_err_cnt.
6889
6890sc1_http_err_rate
6891sc2_http_err_rate
6892 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
6893 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
6894 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
6895 src_http_err_rate.
6896
6897sc1_http_req_cnt
6898sc2_http_req_cnt
6899 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6900 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6901 src_http_req_cnt.
6902
6903sc1_http_req_rate
6904sc2_http_req_rate
6905 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6906 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
6907 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6908 src_http_req_rate.
6909
6910sc1_inc_gpc0
6911sc2_inc_gpc0
6912 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
6913 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
6914 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
6915 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
6916 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
6917 when a first ACL was verified :
6918
6919 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6920 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
6921 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
6922
6923sc1_kbytes_in
6924sc2_kbytes_in
6925 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
6926 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6927 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6928 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
6929
6930sc1_kbytes_out
6931sc2_kbytes_out
6932 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
6933 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6934 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6935 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
6936
6937sc1_sess_cnt
6938sc2_sess_cnt
6939 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
6940 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
6941 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
6942 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
6943 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
6944 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
6945
6946sc1_sess_rate
6947sc2_sess_rate
6948 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
6949 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
6950 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
6951 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
6952 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
6953 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
6954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006955so_id <integer>
6956 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
6957
6958src <ip_address>
6959 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
6960 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
6961 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
6962
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006963src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
6964src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
6965 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6966 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6967 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006968 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006969
6970src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
6971src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
6972 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
6973 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6974 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006975 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006976
6977src_conn_cnt <integer>
6978src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
6979 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6980 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6981 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006982 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006983
6984src_conn_cur <integer>
6985src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
6986 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
6987 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
6988 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006989 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006990
6991src_conn_rate <integer>
6992src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
6993 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
6994 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6995 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006996 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006997
6998src_get_gpc0 <integer>
6999src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7000 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7001 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7002 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007003 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007004
7005src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7006src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7007 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7008 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7009 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007010 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007011
7012src_http_err_rate <integer>
7013src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7014 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7015 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7016 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7017 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007018 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007019
7020src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7021src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7022 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7023 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7024 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007025 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007026
7027src_http_req_rate <integer>
7028src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7029 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7030 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7031 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7032 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007033 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007034
7035src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7036src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7037 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7038 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7039 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7040 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7041 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7042 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7043
7044 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7045 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007046 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007047
7048src_kbytes_in <integer>
7049src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7050 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7051 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7052 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7053 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007054 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007055
7056src_kbytes_out <integer>
7057src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7058 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7059 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7060 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7061 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007062 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007063
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007064src_port <integer>
7065 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007066
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007067src_sess_cnt <integer>
7068src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7069 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7070 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7071 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7072 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007073 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007074
7075src_sess_rate <integer>
7076src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7077 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7078 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7079 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7080 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007081 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007082
7083src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7084src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007085 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007086 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7087 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007088 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7089 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7090 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007091 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007092
7093 Example :
7094 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7095 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7096 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7097 listen ssh
7098 bind :22
7099 mode tcp
7100 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007101 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007102 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7103 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7104
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007105srv_is_up(<server>)
7106srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7107 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7108 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7109 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7110 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7111 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7112 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7113 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7114 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020071177.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7118---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007119
7120A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7121during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007122through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7123keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007124
7125req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007126 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007127 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7128 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7129 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7130 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7131 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7132 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7133
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007134req_proto_http
7135 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7136 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007137 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007138 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7139 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7140
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007141req_rdp_cookie <string>
7142req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7143 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7144 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7145 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7146 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7147 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7148 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7149 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7150 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7151
7152req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7153req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7154 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7155 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7156 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7157 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7158 cookies.
7159
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007160req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7161 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7162 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7163 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7164 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7165 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7166 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7167 with TCP request content inspection.
7168
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007169wait_end
7170 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7171 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7172 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7173 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7174 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7175 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7176 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7177 inspection.
7178
7179 Examples :
7180 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7181 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7182 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7183
7184 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7185 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7186 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7187 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7188 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7189 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7190 tcp-request content reject
7191
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071937.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7194--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007195
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007196A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007197application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7198read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7199than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7200
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007201hdr <string>
7202hdr(header) <string>
7203 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7204 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7205 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7206 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7207 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7208
7209 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7210 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7211 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7212
7213 hdr(Connection) -i close
7214
7215hdr_beg <string>
7216hdr_beg(header) <string>
7217 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7218 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7219 response headers sent by the server.
7220
7221hdr_cnt <integer>
7222hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7223 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7224 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7225 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7226 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7227 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7228 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7229 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7230
7231hdr_dir <string>
7232hdr_dir(header) <string>
7233 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7234 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7235 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7236 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7237 headers sent by the server.
7238
7239hdr_dom <string>
7240hdr_dom(header) <string>
7241 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7242 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7243 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7244 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7245 server.
7246
7247hdr_end <string>
7248hdr_end(header) <string>
7249 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7250 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7251 response headers sent by the server.
7252
7253hdr_ip <ip_address>
7254hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7255 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7256 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7257 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7258 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7259
7260hdr_reg <regex>
7261hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7262 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7263 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7264 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7265 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7266 response headers sent by the server.
7267
7268hdr_sub <string>
7269hdr_sub(header) <string>
7270 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7271 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7272 response headers sent by the server.
7273
7274hdr_val <integer>
7275hdr_val(header) <integer>
7276 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7277 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7278 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7279 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7280
7281http_auth(userlist)
7282http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7283 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7284 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7285 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7286 of specified groups.
7287
7288 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7289
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007290http_req_first
7291 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7292 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7293 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7294 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7295
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007296method <string>
7297 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7298 already check for most common methods.
7299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007300path <string>
7301 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7302 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7303 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7304
7305path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007306 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7307 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007309path_dir <string>
7310 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7311 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7312 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7313 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7314
7315path_dom <string>
7316 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7317 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7318 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7319
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007320path_end <string>
7321 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7322 control file name extension.
7323
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007324path_reg <regex>
7325 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7326 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7327 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7328
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007329path_sub <string>
7330 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7331 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7332 "path_dir".
7333
7334req_ver <string>
7335 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7336 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7337
7338status <integer>
7339 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7340 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7341 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7342
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007343url <string>
7344 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7345 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7346
7347url_beg <string>
7348 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7349 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7350
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007351url_dir <string>
7352 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7353 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7354 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7355 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7356
7357url_dom <string>
7358 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7359 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7360 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7361
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007362url_end <string>
7363 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7364 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007365
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007366url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007367 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7368 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007369 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007370
7371url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007372 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7373 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007374 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007375 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007376
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007377url_reg <regex>
7378 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7379 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7380 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007381
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007382url_sub <string>
7383 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7384 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007385
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073877.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7388---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007390Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7391every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007392order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007394ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7395---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007396FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007397HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007398HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7399HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007400HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7401HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7402HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7403HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7404LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007405METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7406METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7407METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7408METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7409METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7410METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007411RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007412REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007413TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007414WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7415---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007416
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074187.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7419----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007421Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7422combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007424 - AND (implicit)
7425 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7426 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007428A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007430 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007431
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007432Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7433indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007435For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7436"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7437requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7438is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007440 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7441 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7442 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7443 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007445To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7446and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007448 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7449 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7450 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7451 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007453 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7454 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7455 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7456 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007457
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007458It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7459expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7460be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7461the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7462
7463 The following rule :
7464
7465 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7466 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7467
7468 Can also be written that way :
7469
7470 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7471
7472It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7473to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7474simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7475sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7476good use is the following :
7477
7478 With named ACLs :
7479
7480 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7481 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7482 monitor fail if site_dead
7483
7484 With anonymous ACLs :
7485
7486 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007488See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007489
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007490
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010074917.8. Pattern extraction
7492-----------------------
7493
7494The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7495response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7496for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7497
7498All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7499"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7500begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7501arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7502much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7503equivalent used in ACLs.
7504
7505The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7506
7507 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7508 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7509
7510 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7511 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7512 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7513 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7514
7515 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7516 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7517 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7518 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7519 type integer and only works with such tables.
7520
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007521 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7522 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7523 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7524 x-forwarded-for header.
7525
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007526
7527The currently available list of transformations include :
7528
7529 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7530 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7531 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7532
7533 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7534 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7535 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7536
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007537 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7538 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7539 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7540 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7541 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7542
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075448. Logging
7545----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007546
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007547One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7548provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7549very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7550provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7551state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007552to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007553headers.
7554
7555In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7556about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7557send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7558
7559 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7560 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7561 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7562 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7563 at the termination.
7564
7565The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7566allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7567as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7568while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7569real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7570delay.
7571
7572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075738.1. Log levels
7574---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007575
7576TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7577source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7578HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7579in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7580particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007581syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007582facilities.
7583
7584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075858.2. Log formats
7586----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007587
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007588HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007589and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7590the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7591formats are the following ones :
7592
7593 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7594 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7595 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7596 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7597 extents.
7598
7599 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7600 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7601 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7602 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7603 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7604
7605 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7606 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7607 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7608 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7609 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7610
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007611 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7612 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7613 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7614 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7615
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007616Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7617specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7618field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7619servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7620always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7621identifier.
7622
7623Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7624 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7625 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7626 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7627 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7628
7629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076308.2.1. Default log format
7631-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007632
7633This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7634as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7635format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7636
7637 Example :
7638 listen www
7639 mode http
7640 log global
7641 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7642
7643 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7644 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7645 (www/HTTP)
7646
7647 Field Format Extract from the example above
7648 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7649 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7650 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7651 4 'to' to
7652 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7653 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7654
7655Detailed fields description :
7656 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7657 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7658 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7659 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7660 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7661 and processed the connection.
7662 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7663
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007664In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
7665"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
7666connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
7667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007668It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7669will eventually disappear.
7670
7671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076728.2.2. TCP log format
7673---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007674
7675The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7676is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7677information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7678counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7679emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7680environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7681the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7682sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007683specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7684not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7685fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7686marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007687
7688 Example :
7689 frontend fnt
7690 mode tcp
7691 option tcplog
7692 log global
7693 default_backend bck
7694
7695 backend bck
7696 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7697
7698 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7699 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7700 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7701
7702 Field Format Extract from the example above
7703 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7704 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7705 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7706 4 frontend_name fnt
7707 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7708 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7709 7 bytes_read* 212
7710 8 termination_state --
7711 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7712 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7713
7714Detailed fields description :
7715 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007716 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
7717 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
7718 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
7719 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
7720 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007721
7722 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007723 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
7724 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
7725 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007726
7727 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7728 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7729 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7730 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7731
7732 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7733 and processed the connection.
7734
7735 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7736 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7737 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7738 applications.
7739
7740 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7741 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7742 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7743 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
7744 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
7745
7746 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7747 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7748 See "Timers" below for more details.
7749
7750 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7751 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7752 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
7753 "Timers" below for more details.
7754
7755 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7756 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7757 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7758 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7759 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7760 details.
7761
7762 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
7763 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
7764 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
7765 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
7766 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
7767
7768 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7769 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7770 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
7771 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
7772 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
7773 for more details.
7774
7775 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7776 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7777 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
7778 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
7779 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007780 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007781
7782 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7783 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7784 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7785 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7786 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7787 caused by a denial of service attack.
7788
7789 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7790 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7791 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7792 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7793 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7794 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7795 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7796 denial of service attack.
7797
7798 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7799 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7800 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7801 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7802 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7803 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7804 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7805 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
7806 be processed than on other servers.
7807
7808 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7809 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7810 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7811 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7812 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7813 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7814 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7815 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7816 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7817 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7818 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7819 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7820 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7821
7822 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7823 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7824 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7825 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7826 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7827 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7828 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7829 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7830
7831 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7832 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7833 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7834 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7835 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7836 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7837 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7838 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7839 occurs.
7840
7841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078428.2.3. HTTP log format
7843----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007844
7845The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
7846is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
7847the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
7848are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
7849emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
7850generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
7851"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
7852which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007853frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
7854is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007855
7856Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
7857slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
7858with a star ('*') after the field name below.
7859
7860 Example :
7861 frontend http-in
7862 mode http
7863 option httplog
7864 log global
7865 default_backend bck
7866
7867 backend static
7868 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7869
7870 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7871 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7872 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007873 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007874
7875 Field Format Extract from the example above
7876 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
7877 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
7878 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
7879 4 frontend_name http-in
7880 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
7881 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
7882 7 status_code 200
7883 8 bytes_read* 2750
7884 9 captured_request_cookie -
7885 10 captured_response_cookie -
7886 11 termination_state ----
7887 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
7888 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7889 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
7890 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
7891 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007892
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007893
7894Detailed fields description :
7895 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007896 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
7897 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
7898 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
7899 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
7900 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007901
7902 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01007903 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
7904 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
7905 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007906
7907 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
7908 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
7909 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
7910 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
7911 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
7912
7913 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7914 and processed the connection.
7915
7916 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7917 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7918 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
7919
7920 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7921 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7922 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7923 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
7924 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
7925 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
7926
7927 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
7928 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
7929 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
7930 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
7931 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
7932 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
7933
7934 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7935 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7936 See "Timers" below for more details.
7937
7938 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7939 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7940 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
7941 below for more details.
7942
7943 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
7944 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
7945 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
7946 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
7947 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
7948 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
7949 for more details.
7950
7951 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7952 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7953 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7954 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7955 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7956 details.
7957
7958 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
7959 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
7960 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
7961
7962 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
7963 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
7964 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
7965 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
7966 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
7967 overflowing.
7968
7969 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
7970 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
7971 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
7972 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
7973 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
7974 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
7975 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
7976 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7977
7978 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
7979 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
7980 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
7981 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
7982 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
7983 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
7984 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
7985 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7986
7987 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7988 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7989 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
7990 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
7991 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
7992 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
7993 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
7994
7995 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7996 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7997 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
7998 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
7999 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008000 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008001 system.
8002
8003 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8004 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8005 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8006 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8007 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8008 caused by a denial of service attack.
8009
8010 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8011 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8012 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8013 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8014 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8015 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8016 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8017 denial of service attack.
8018
8019 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8020 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8021 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8022 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8023 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8024 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8025 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8026 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8027 processed than on other servers.
8028
8029 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8030 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8031 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8032 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8033 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8034 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8035 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8036 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8037 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8038 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8039 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8040 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8041 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8042
8043 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8044 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8045 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8046 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8047 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8048 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8049 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8050 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8051
8052 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8053 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8054 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8055 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8056 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8057 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8058 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8059 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8060 occurs.
8061
8062 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8063 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8064 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8065 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8066 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8067 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8068 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8069 cookies" below for more details.
8070
8071 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8072 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8073 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8074 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8075 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8076 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8077 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8078 and cookies" below for more details.
8079
8080 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8081 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8082 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8083 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8084 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8085 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8086 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8087 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8088
8089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080908.3. Advanced logging options
8091-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008092
8093Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8094just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8095options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8096for more information about their usage.
8097
8098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080998.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8100------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008101
8102It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8103haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8104commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8105monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8106ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8107
8108 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8109 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8110 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8111 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8112
8113 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8114 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8115 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8116 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8117 such as other load-balancers.
8118
8119 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8120 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8121 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8122
8123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081248.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8125----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008126
8127The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8128what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8129or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8130"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8131just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8132log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8133after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8134is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8135with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8136with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8137
8138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081398.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8140------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008141
8142Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8143for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8144"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8145retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8146raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8147a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8148file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8149you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8150"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8151
8152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081538.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8154--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008155
8156Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8157multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8158them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8159"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8160logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8161error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8162and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8163too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8164useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8165alternative.
8166
8167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081688.4. Timing events
8169------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008170
8171Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8172reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8173the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8174frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8175mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8176
8177 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8178 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8179 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8180 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8181 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8182
8183 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8184 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8185 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8186 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8187 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8188
8189 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8190 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8191 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8192 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8193 connection never established.
8194
8195 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8196 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8197 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8198 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8199 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8200 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8201 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8202 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8203 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8204 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8205 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8206
8207 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8208 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8209 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8210 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8211 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8212
8213 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8214
8215 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8216 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8217 negative.
8218
8219These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8220protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8221that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008222due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008223close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8224session has been aborted on timeout.
8225
8226Most common cases :
8227
8228 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8229 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8230 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8231 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8232 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8233 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8234 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8235 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8236 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008237 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8238 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8239 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008240
8241 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8242 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8243 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8244 of ms on remote networks.
8245
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008246 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8247 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8248 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008249
8250 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8251 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8252 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8253 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8254 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8255 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8256 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8257 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8258 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8259 to the server until another one is released.
8260
8261Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8262
8263 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8264 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8265 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8266
8267 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8268 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8269 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8270
8271 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8272 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8273 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8274 flags.
8275
8276 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8277 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8278 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8279 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8280 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8281 the client connection was maintained open.
8282
8283 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8284 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8285 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8286 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8287
8288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082898.5. Session state at disconnection
8290-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008291
8292TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8293"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
82942-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8295each of which has a special meaning :
8296
8297 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8298 session to terminate :
8299
8300 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8301
8302 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8303 server explicitly refused it.
8304
8305 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8306 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8307 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8308 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8309 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8310 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8311
8312 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8313 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8314 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8315 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8316 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8317
8318 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8319 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8320 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8321 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8322 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8323
8324 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8325 send or receive data.
8326
8327 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8328 send or receive data.
8329
8330 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8331 with nothing left in the buffers.
8332
8333 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8334
8335 R : th proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
8336 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8337
8338 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8339 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8340 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8341 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8342 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8343
8344 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8345 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8346
8347 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8348 server (HTTP only).
8349
8350 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8351
8352 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8353 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8354 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8355
8356 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8357 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8358 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8359
8360 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8361
8362 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8363 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8364
8365 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8366 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8367 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8368
8369 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8370 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008371 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8372 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008373
8374 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8375 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8376 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8377 another server.
8378
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008379 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008380 server.
8381
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008382 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8383 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8384 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8385 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8386
8387 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8388 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8389 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8390 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8391
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008392 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8393
8394 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8395 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8396
8397 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8398
8399 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8400 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8401 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8402
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008403 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8404 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8405 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8406 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8407 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008409 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8410
8411 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8412 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8413
8414 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8415
8416 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8417
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008418The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8419was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008420helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8421starvation, attacks, etc...
8422
8423The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8424alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8425easier finding and understanding.
8426
8427 Flags Reason
8428
8429 -- Normal termination.
8430
8431 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8432 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8433 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8434 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8435
8436 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8437 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8438 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8439 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8440 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8441 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008442
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008443 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8444 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8445 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8446
8447 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8448 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8449 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8450
8451 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8452 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8453 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8454 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8455 the server takes too long to respond.
8456
8457 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8458 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8459 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8460 long a time to respond.
8461
8462 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8463 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8464 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8465 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8466 and the client.
8467
8468 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8469 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8470 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8471 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8472 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8473 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8474
8475 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8476 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008477 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8478 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8479 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8480 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008482 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008483 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8484 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8485 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8486 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8487 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8488
8489 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8490 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8491 503 or 504 here.
8492
8493 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8494 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8495 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8496 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8497 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8498
8499 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8500 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008501 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008502 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8503 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8504
8505 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8506 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8507 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8508 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8509 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8510 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8511 between haproxy and the server.
8512
8513 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8514 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8515 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8516 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8517 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8518 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8519 solution is to fix the application.
8520
8521 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8522 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8523 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8524 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8525 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8526 external attacks.
8527
8528 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8529 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8530 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8531 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8532 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8533
8534 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8535 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8536 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8537 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
8538 containing unauthorized characters.
8539
8540 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8541 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8542 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8543 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8544
8545 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8546 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8547 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8548 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8549
8550 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8551 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8552 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8553 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8554
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008555The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8556persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8557important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8558re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8559
8560 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8561
8562 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8563 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8564 set on a GET request.
8565
8566 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8567 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8568 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8569 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8570
8571 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8572 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8573 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8574
8575 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8576 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8577 already got a cookie.
8578
8579 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8580 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8581 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8582 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8583 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8584
8585 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8586 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8587 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8588
8589 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8590 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8591 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8592
8593 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8594 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8595
8596 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8597 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8598 then advertised in the response.
8599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086018.6. Non-printable characters
8602-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008603
8604In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8605consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8606converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8607prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8608being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8609escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8610is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8611'}' when logging headers.
8612
8613Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8614issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8615containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8616
8617Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8618the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8619performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8620
8621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086228.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8623---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008624
8625Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8626achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008627section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008628cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8629the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8630the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008631locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008632not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8633user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8634a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8635wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8636
8637 Examples :
8638 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8639 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8640
8641 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8642 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8643
8644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086458.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8646---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008647
8648Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8649proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8650the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8651server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8652
8653Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8654response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008655section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008656
8657It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008658time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8659appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008660are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8661and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8662follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8663request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8664in the logs.
8665
8666 Example :
8667 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8668 listen proxy-out
8669 mode http
8670 option httplog
8671 option logasap
8672 log global
8673 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8674
8675 # log the name of the virtual server
8676 capture request header Host len 20
8677
8678 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8679 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8680
8681 # log the beginning of the referrer
8682 capture request header Referer len 20
8683
8684 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8685 capture response header Server len 20
8686
8687 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8688 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8689
8690 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8691 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8692
8693 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8694 capture response header Via len 20
8695
8696 # log the URL location during a redirection
8697 capture response header Location len 20
8698
8699 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8700 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8701 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8702 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8703 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8704
8705 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8706 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8707 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8708 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008709 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008710
8711 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8712 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8713 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8714 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8715 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008716 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008717
8718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087198.9. Examples of logs
8720---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008721
8722These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8723them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8724reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8725
8726 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8727 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8728 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8729
8730 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
8731 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
8732
8733 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
8734 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
8735 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8736
8737 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
8738 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
8739
8740 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
8741 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8742 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8743
8744 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008745 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008746 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
8747 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
8748
8749 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
8750 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
8751 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
8752
8753 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
8754 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
8755 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
8756 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
8757 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
8758 to return the 502 and not the server.
8759
8760 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008761 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008762
8763 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
8764 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
8765 Nothing was sent to any server.
8766
8767 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
8768 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
8769
8770 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
8771 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
8772 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
8773 send a 408 return code to the client.
8774
8775 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
8776 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
8777
8778 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
8779 5 seconds ("c----").
8780
8781 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
8782 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008783 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008784
8785 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008786 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008787 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
8788 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
8789 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
8790 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
8791 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008792
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087949. Statistics and monitoring
8795----------------------------
8796
8797It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
8798mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
8799CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
8800Unix socket.
8801
8802
88039.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008804---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008805
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01008806The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
8807page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
8808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008809 0. pxname: proxy name
8810 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
8811 for server)
8812 2. qcur: current queued requests
8813 3. qmax: max queued requests
8814 4. scur: current sessions
8815 5. smax: max sessions
8816 6. slim: sessions limit
8817 7. stot: total sessions
8818 8. bin: bytes in
8819 9. bout: bytes out
8820 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008821 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008822 12. ereq: request errors
8823 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008824 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008825 15. wretr: retries (warning)
8826 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01008827 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008828 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
8829 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
8830 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
8831 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
8832 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
8833 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
8834 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
8835 25. qlimit: queue limit
8836 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
8837 27. iid: unique proxy id
8838 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
8839 29. throttle: warm up status
8840 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
8841 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008842 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02008843 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
8844 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
8845 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008846 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008847 UNK -> unknown
8848 INI -> initializing
8849 SOCKERR -> socket error
8850 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
8851 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
8852 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
8853 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
8854 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
8855 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
8856 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
8857 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
8858 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
8859 disable-on-404
8860 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
8861 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
8862 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008863 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
8864 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008865 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
8866 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
8867 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
8868 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
8869 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
8870 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008871 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
8872 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
8873 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
8874 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008875 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
8876 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008877
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088799.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008880-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008881
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008882The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008883must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
8884is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
8885a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
8886risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
8887followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
8888given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
8889then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
8890to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008891
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008892It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
8893on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
8894own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896clear counters
8897 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
8898 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
8899 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
8900 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
8901 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8902
8903clear counters all
8904 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
8905 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
8906 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
8907
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008908clear table <table> key <key>
8909 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
8910 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
8911 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
8912 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
8913 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
8914 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
8915 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
8916 usuall enough.
8917
8918 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008919 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8920 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8921 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
8922 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
8923 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8924 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008925
8926 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8927
8928 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008929 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:1
8930 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8931 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008932
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008933disable server <backend>/<server>
8934 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
8935 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
8936 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
8937 during the maintenance.
8938
8939 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
8940 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
8941
8942 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8943 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8944
8945 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8946 level "admin".
8947
8948enable server <backend>/<server>
8949 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
8950 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
8951
8952 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8953 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8954
8955 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8956 level "admin".
8957
8958get weight <backend>/<server>
8959 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
8960 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
8961 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
8962 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
8963 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
8964 dash ('#').
8965
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008966help
8967 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
8968 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008969
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008970prompt
8971 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
8972 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
8973 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
8974 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
8975 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
8976 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
8977 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
8978 command.
8979
8980quit
8981 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008983set timeout cli <delay>
8984 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
8985 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
8986 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
8987
8988set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
8989 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
8990 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
8991 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
8992 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
8993 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
8994 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
8995 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
8996 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
8997 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
8998 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
8999 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9000 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9001 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9002 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9003
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009004show errors [<iid>]
9005 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9006 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009007 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9008 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9009 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009010
9011 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9012 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9013 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9014 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9015 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9016 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9017 are reported too.
9018
9019 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9020 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9021 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9022 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9023 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9024 code.
9025
9026 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9027 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9028 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9029 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9030 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9031 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9032 line.
9033
9034 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009035 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9036 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009037 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9038 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9039
9040 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9041 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9042 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9043 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9044 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9045 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9046 00204+ minal\r\n
9047 00211 \r\n
9048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009049 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009050 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9051 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9052 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9053 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9054 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9055 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009056
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009057show info
9058 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9059
9060show sess
9061 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009062 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9063 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9064
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009065show sess <id>
9066 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9067 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9068 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9069 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9070 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9071 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009072
9073show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9074 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9075 possible to dump only selected items :
9076 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9077 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9078 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9079 for example:
9080 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9081 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9082 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9083
9084 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009085 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9086 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009087 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9088 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9089 Nbproc: 1
9090 Process_num: 1
9091 (...)
9092
9093 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9094 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9095 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9096 (...)
9097 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9098
9099 $
9100
9101 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9102 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9103 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9104 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009105 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009106
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009107show table
9108 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9109 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9110 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9111 entries currently in use.
9112
9113 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009114 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9115 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9116 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009117
9118show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9119 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9120 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9121 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9122 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9123 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9124 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9125 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9126 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9127 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9128 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9129 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9130 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9131 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9132 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9133
9134 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009135 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9136 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9137 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9138 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9139 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9140 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009141
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009142 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9143 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9144 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9145 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009146
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009147 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9148 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9149 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9150 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9151 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009152
9153 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9154 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9155 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9156 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9157 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9158
9159 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9160 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9161 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009162 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9163 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009164 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9165 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009167/*
9168 * Local variables:
9169 * fill-column: 79
9170 * End:
9171 */